]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blob - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
* doc/tm.texi.in (Cond. Exec. Macros): Rename node from this ...
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2 @c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
5 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7 @node Target Macros
8 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9 @cindex machine description macros
10 @cindex target description macros
11 @cindex macros, target description
12 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28 @menu
29 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37 * Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59 * Misc:: Everything else.
60 @end menu
61
62 @node Target Structure
63 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64 @cindex target hooks
65 @cindex target functions
66
67 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75 @smallexample
76 #include "target.h"
77 #include "target-def.h"
78
79 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85 @end smallexample
86 @end deftypevar
87
88 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92 @code{targetm} structure.
93
94 @node Driver
95 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
96 @cindex driver
97 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
98
99 @c prevent bad page break with this line
100 You can control the compilation driver.
101
102 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
103 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
104 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
105
106 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
107 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
108 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
109 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
110 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
111 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
112
113 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
114 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
115 that the other specs are easier to write.
116
117 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
118 @end defmac
119
120 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
121 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
122 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
123 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
124 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
125
126 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
127 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
128 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
129 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
130 everywhere it occurs.
131
132 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
133 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
134 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
135
136 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
137 @end defmac
138
139 @defmac CPP_SPEC
140 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
141 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
142 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
143
144 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
145 @end defmac
146
147 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
148 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
149 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
150 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
151 @end defmac
152
153 @defmac CC1_SPEC
154 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
155 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
156 front ends.
157 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
158 for GCC to pass to front ends.
159
160 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
161 @end defmac
162
163 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
164 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
165 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
166 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
167
168 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
169 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
170 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
171 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
172 @end defmac
173
174 @defmac ASM_SPEC
175 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
176 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
177 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
178 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
179
180 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
181 @end defmac
182
183 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
184 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
185 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
186 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
187 an example of this.
188
189 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
190 @end defmac
191
192 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
193 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
194 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
195 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
196 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
197 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
198
199 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
200 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
201 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
202 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
203 @end defmac
204
205 @defmac LINK_SPEC
206 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
207 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
208 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
209
210 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
211 @end defmac
212
213 @defmac LIB_SPEC
214 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
215 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
216 command given to the linker.
217
218 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
219 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
220 @end defmac
221
222 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
223 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
224 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
225 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
226 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
227
228 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
229 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
230 @end defmac
231
232 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
233 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
234 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
235 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
236 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
237 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
238 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
239 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
240 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
241 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
242 @end defmac
243
244 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
245 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
246 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
247 generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
248 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
249 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
250 @end defmac
251
252 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
253 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
254 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
255 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
256 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
257 @end defmac
258
259 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
260 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
261 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
262 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
263
264 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
265 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
266 @end defmac
267
268 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
269 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
270 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
271 the very end of the command given to the linker.
272
273 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
274 @end defmac
275
276 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
277 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
278 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
279 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
280 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
281 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
282 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
283 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
284 @end defmac
285
286 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
287 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
288 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
289 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
290 @end defmac
291
292 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
293 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
294 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
295 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
296 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
297 @end defmac
298
299 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
300 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
301 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
302 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
303
304 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
305 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
306 string constant that provides the specification.
307
308 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
309
310 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
311 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
312 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
313 these definitions.
314
315 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
316 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
317 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
318 used.
319
320 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
321
322 @smallexample
323 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
324 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
325
326 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
327 @end smallexample
328
329 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
330 @smallexample
331 #undef CPP_SPEC
332 #define CPP_SPEC \
333 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
334 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
335 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
336 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
337
338 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
339 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
340 @end smallexample
341
342 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
343 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
344
345 @smallexample
346 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
347 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
348 @end smallexample
349 @end defmac
350
351 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
352 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
353 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
354 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
355 @end defmac
356
357 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
358 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
359 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
360 @end defmac
361
362 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
363 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
364 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
365 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
366 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
367 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
368 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
369 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
370 @end defmac
371
372 @defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
373 A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
374 directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
375 removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
376 @end defmac
377
378 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
379 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
380 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
381 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
382 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
383
384 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
385 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
386 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
387 @xref{Target Fragment}.
388 @end defmac
389
390 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
391 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
392 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
393 indicates an absolute file name.
394 @end defmac
395
396 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
397 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
398 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
399 when the compiler is built as a cross
400 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
401 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
402 @end defmac
403
404 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
405 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
406 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
407 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
408 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
409 is built as a cross compiler.
410 @end defmac
411
412 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
413 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
414 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
415 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
416 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
417 is built as a cross compiler.
418 @end defmac
419
420 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
421 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
422 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
423 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
424 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
425 is built as a cross compiler.
426 @end defmac
427
428 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
429 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
430 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
431 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
432 @end defmac
433
434 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
435 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
436 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
437 cross compiler.
438 @end defmac
439
440 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
441 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
442 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
443 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
444 initialize the necessary environment variables.
445 @end defmac
446
447 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
448 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
449 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
450 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
451 comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
452
453 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
454 replacement.
455 @end defmac
456
457 @defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
458 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
459 system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
460 directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
461 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
462
463 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
464 specified.
465 @end defmac
466
467 @defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
468 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
469 standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
470 try when searching for header files.
471
472 Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
473 @file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
474 @end defmac
475
476 @defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
477 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
478 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
479 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
480 @end defmac
481
482 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
483 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
484 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
485 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
486 @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
487 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
488 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
489 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
490 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
491
492 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
493 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
494 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
495 for C++-only directories,
496 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
497 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
498 the array with a null element.
499
500 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
501 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
502 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
503 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
504
505 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
506
507 @smallexample
508 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
509 @{ \
510 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
511 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
512 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
513 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
514 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
515 @}
516 @end smallexample
517 @end defmac
518
519 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
520
521 @enumerate
522 @item
523 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
524
525 @item
526 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
527 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
528 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
529
530 @item
531 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
532
533 @item
534 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
535 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
536
537 @item
538 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
539
540 @item
541 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
542
543 @item
544 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
545 compiler.
546 @end enumerate
547
548 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
549
550 @enumerate
551 @item
552 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
553
554 @item
555 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
556 value based on the installed toolchain location.
557
558 @item
559 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
560 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
561
562 @item
563 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
564 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
565
566 @item
567 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
568
569 @item
570 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
571 compiler.
572
573 @item
574 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
575 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
576
577 @item
578 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
579 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
580
581 @item
582 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
583 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
584 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
585
586 @item
587 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
588 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
589 @file{/lib/}.
590
591 @item
592 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
593 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
594 @file{/usr/lib/}.
595 @end enumerate
596
597 @node Run-time Target
598 @section Run-time Target Specification
599 @cindex run-time target specification
600 @cindex predefined macros
601 @cindex target specifications
602
603 @c prevent bad page break with this line
604 Here are run-time target specifications.
605
606 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
607 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
608 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
609 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
610 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
611 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
612 finished command line option processing your code can use those
613 results freely.
614
615 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
616 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
617 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
618 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
619
620 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
621 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
622 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
623 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
624 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
625 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
626 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
627 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
628 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
629 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
630
631 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
632 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
633 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
634 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
635 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
636 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
637 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
638 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
639 preprocessing.
640 @end defmac
641
642 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
643 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
644 and is used for the target operating system instead.
645 @end defmac
646
647 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
648 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
649 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
650 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
651 it yourself.
652 @end defmac
653
654 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
655 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
656 any target-specific headers.
657 @end deftypevar
658
659 @hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
660 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
661 Its default setting is 0.
662 @end deftypevr
663
664 @cindex optional hardware or system features
665 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
666
667 @hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
668 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
669 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
670 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
671 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
672 definition does nothing but return true.
673
674 @var{code} specifies the @code{OPT_@var{name}} enumeration value
675 associated with the selected option; @var{name} is just a rendering of
676 the option name in which non-alphanumeric characters are replaced by
677 underscores. @var{arg} specifies the string argument and is null if
678 no argument was given. If the option is flagged as a @code{UInteger}
679 (@pxref{Option properties}), @var{value} is the numeric value of the
680 argument. Otherwise @var{value} is 1 if the positive form of the
681 option was used and 0 if the ``no-'' form was.
682 @end deftypefn
683
684 @hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
685 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
686 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
687 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
688 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
689 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
690 default definition does nothing but return false.
691
692 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
693 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
694 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
695 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
696 @end deftypefn
697
698 @hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT
699
700 @hook TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P
701
702 @hook TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG
703
704 @defmac TARGET_VERSION
705 This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
706 describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
707 description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
708
709 @smallexample
710 #ifdef MOTOROLA
711 #define TARGET_VERSION \
712 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
713 #else
714 #define TARGET_VERSION \
715 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
716 #endif
717 @end smallexample
718 @end defmac
719
720 @hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
721 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
722 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
723 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
724 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
725 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
726 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
727 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
728 @end deftypefn
729
730 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
731 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
732 but is only used in the C
733 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
734 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
735 frontends.
736 @end defmac
737
738 @hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
739 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
740 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
741 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
742 options are processed once
743 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
744 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
745 options passed explicily.
746
747 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
748 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
749 @code{optimize} attribute.
750 @end deftypevr
751
752 @hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
753
754 @hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
755
756 @hook TARGET_HELP
757 This hook is called in response to the user invoking
758 @option{--target-help} on the command line. It gives the target a
759 chance to display extra information on the target specific command
760 line options found in its @file{.opt} file.
761 @end deftypefn
762
763 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
764 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
765 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
766 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
767 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
768 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
769
770 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
771 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
772 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
773 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
774 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
775 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
776 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
777
778 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
779 is 0.
780 @end defmac
781
782 @node Per-Function Data
783 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
784 @cindex per-function data
785 @cindex data structures
786
787 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
788 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
789 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
790 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
791 when another one comes along.
792
793 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
794 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
795 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
796 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
797 to their own specific data.
798
799 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
800 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
801 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
802 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
803
804 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
805 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
806 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
807 function, for level 0.
808
809 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
810 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
811 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
812 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
813 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
814 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
815 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
816 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
817 longer supported.
818
819 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
820 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
821 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
822 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
823 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
824 @end defmac
825
826 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
827 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
828 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
829 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
830 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
831 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
832
833 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
834 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
835 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
836 @end deftypevar
837
838 @node Storage Layout
839 @section Storage Layout
840 @cindex storage layout
841
842 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
843 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
844 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
845 @xref{Run-time Target}.
846
847 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
848 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
849 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
850 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
851 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
852 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
853 macro need not be a constant.
854
855 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
856 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
857 @end defmac
858
859 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
860 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
861 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
862 @end defmac
863
864 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
865 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
866 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
867 memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
868 order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
869 macro need not be a constant.
870 @end defmac
871
872 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
873 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
874 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
875 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
876 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
877
878 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
879 multi-word integers.
880 @end defmac
881
882 @defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
883 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
884 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
885 @end defmac
886
887 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
888 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
889 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
890 @end defmac
891
892 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
893 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
894 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
895 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
896 @end defmac
897
898 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
899 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
900 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
901 @end defmac
902
903 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
904 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
905 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
906 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
907 @end defmac
908
909 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
910 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
911 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
912 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
913 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
914 @end defmac
915
916 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
917 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
918 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
919 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
920 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
921 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
922 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
923
924 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
925 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
926 @end defmac
927
928 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
929 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
930 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
931 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
932 scalar type.
933
934 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
935 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
936 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
937 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
938 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
939 counterparts.
940
941 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
942 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
943 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
944 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
945 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
946 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
947
948 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
949 @end defmac
950
951 @hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
952 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
953 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
954 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
955 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
956 pointer} types.
957
958 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
959 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
960 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
961 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
962 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
963 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
964 the signedness may be different.
965
966 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
967 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
968 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
969 @end deftypefn
970
971 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
972 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
973 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
974 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
975 size of an integer.
976 @end defmac
977
978 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
979 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
980 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
981 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
982 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
983 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
984 @end defmac
985
986 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
987 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
988 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
989 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
990 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
991 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
992 @end defmac
993
994 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
995 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
996 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
997 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
998 @end defmac
999
1000 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1001 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1002 @end defmac
1003
1004 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1005 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1006 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1007 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1008 @end defmac
1009
1010 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1011 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1012 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1013 @end defmac
1014
1015 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1016 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1017 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1018 @end defmac
1019
1020 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1021 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1022 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1023 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1024 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1025 @end defmac
1026
1027 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1028 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1029 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1030 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1031 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1032 @end defmac
1033
1034 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1035 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1036 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1037 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1038 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1039 field alignment has not been set by the
1040 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1041 @end defmac
1042
1043 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1044 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1045 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1046
1047 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1048
1049 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1050 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1051 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1052 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1053 @end defmac
1054
1055 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1056 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1057 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1058 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1059 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1060
1061 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1062 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1063 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1064 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1065 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1066 @end defmac
1067
1068 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1069 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1070 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1071 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1072 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1073
1074 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1075
1076 @findex strcpy
1077 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1078 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1079 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1080 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1081 @end defmac
1082
1083 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1084 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1085 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1086 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1087 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1088 align the object.
1089
1090 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1091
1092 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1093 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1094 constants can be done inline.
1095 @end defmac
1096
1097 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1098 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1099 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1100 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1101 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1102
1103 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1104
1105 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1106 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1107
1108 It the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1109 @end defmac
1110
1111 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1112 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1113 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1114 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1115 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1116 align the slot.
1117
1118 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1119 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1120 be used.
1121
1122 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1123 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1124
1125 It the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1126 @end defmac
1127
1128 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1129 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1130 variable @var{decl}.
1131
1132 If this macro is not defined, then
1133 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1134 is used.
1135
1136 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1137 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1138
1139 It the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1140 @end defmac
1141
1142 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1143 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1144 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1145 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1146
1147 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1148 @end defmac
1149
1150 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1151 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1152 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1153
1154 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1155 @end defmac
1156
1157 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1158 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1159 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1160
1161 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1162 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1163 @end defmac
1164
1165 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1166 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1167 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1168 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1169 @end defmac
1170
1171 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1172 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1173 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1174
1175 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1176 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1177 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1178 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1179 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1180
1181 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1182 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1183 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1184 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1185
1186 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1187 structure.
1188
1189 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1190 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1191
1192 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1193 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1194 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1195 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1196
1197 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1198 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1199 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1200
1201 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1202 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1203 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1204
1205 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1206 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1207 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1208
1209 @smallexample
1210 struct foo1
1211 @{
1212 char x;
1213 char :0;
1214 char y;
1215 @};
1216
1217 struct foo2
1218 @{
1219 char x;
1220 int :0;
1221 char y;
1222 @};
1223
1224 main ()
1225 @{
1226 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1227 sizeof (struct foo1));
1228 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1229 sizeof (struct foo2));
1230 exit (0);
1231 @}
1232 @end smallexample
1233
1234 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1235 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1236 @end defmac
1237
1238 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1239 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1240 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1241 @end defmac
1242
1243 @hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1244 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1245 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1246 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1247 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1248 @end deftypefn
1249
1250 @hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1251 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1252 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1253 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1254
1255 The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1256 @end deftypefn
1257
1258 @defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1259 Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1260 @code{BLKMODE}.
1261
1262 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1263 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1264 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1265 retain the field's mode.
1266
1267 Normally, this is not needed.
1268 @end defmac
1269
1270 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1271 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1272 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1273 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1274 @var{specified}.
1275
1276 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1277 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1278 @end defmac
1279
1280 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1281 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1282 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1283 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1284 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1285 (DImode)} is assumed.
1286 @end defmac
1287
1288 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1289 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1290 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1291 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1292 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1293 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1294 having its mode specified.
1295
1296 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1297 would most commonly define this macro if the
1298 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1299 64-bit mode.
1300 @end defmac
1301
1302 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1303 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1304 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1305 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1306
1307 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1308 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1309 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1310 @end defmac
1311
1312 @hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1313 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1314 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1315 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1316 targets.
1317 @end deftypefn
1318
1319 @hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1320 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1321 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1322 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1323 targets.
1324 @end deftypefn
1325
1326 @hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1327 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1328 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1329 @end deftypefn
1330
1331 @defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1332 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1333 mode is towards zero.
1334
1335 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1336 floating-point arithmetic.
1337
1338 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1339 @end defmac
1340
1341 @defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1342 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1343 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1344 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1345
1346 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1347 floating-point arithmetic.
1348
1349 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1350 @end defmac
1351
1352 @hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1353 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1354 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1355 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1356 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1357 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1358 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1359 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1360 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1361 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1362 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1363 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1364
1365 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1366 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1367 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1368 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1369 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1370 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1371 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1372
1373 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1374 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1375 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1376 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1377 may affect its placement.
1378 @end deftypefn
1379
1380 @hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1381 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1382 @end deftypefn
1383
1384 @hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1385 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1386 @end deftypefn
1387
1388 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1389 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1390 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1391 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1392 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1393 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1394 usage.
1395 @end deftypefn
1396
1397 @hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1398 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1399 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1400 @end deftypefn
1401
1402 @hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1403 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1404 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1405 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1406 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1407 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1408 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1409 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1410 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1411 string constant.
1412
1413 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1414 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1415 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1416 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1417 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1418 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1419 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1420 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1421 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1422 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1423 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1424 spaces in your string.
1425
1426 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1427 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1428 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1429 before mangling.
1430
1431 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1432 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1433 types.
1434 @end deftypefn
1435
1436 @node Type Layout
1437 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1438
1439 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1440 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1441 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1442 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1443
1444 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1445 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1446 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1447 @end defmac
1448
1449 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1450 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1451 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1452 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1453 unit.)
1454 @end defmac
1455
1456 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1457 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1458 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1459 @end defmac
1460
1461 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1462 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1463 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1464 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1465 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1466 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1467 @end defmac
1468
1469 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1470 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1471 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1472 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1473 macro must be at least 64.
1474 @end defmac
1475
1476 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1477 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1478 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1479 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1480 @end defmac
1481
1482 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1483 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1484 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1485 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1486 @end defmac
1487
1488 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1489 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1490 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1491 @end defmac
1492
1493 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1494 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1495 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1496 words.
1497 @end defmac
1498
1499 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1500 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1501 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1502 words.
1503 @end defmac
1504
1505 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1506 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1507 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1508 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1509 @end defmac
1510
1511 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1512 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1513 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1514 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1515 @end defmac
1516
1517 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1518 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1519 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1520 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1521 @end defmac
1522
1523 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1524 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1525 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1526 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1527 @end defmac
1528
1529 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1530 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1531 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1532 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1533 @end defmac
1534
1535 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1536 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1537 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1538 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1539 @end defmac
1540
1541 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1542 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1543 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1544 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1545 @end defmac
1546
1547 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1548 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1549 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1550 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1551 @end defmac
1552
1553 @defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1554 Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1555 if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1556 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1557 default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1558 @end defmac
1559
1560 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1561 Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1562 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1563 @code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1564 anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1565 or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1566 otherwise it is 0.
1567 @end defmac
1568
1569 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1570 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1571 @code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1572 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1573 is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1574 @end defmac
1575
1576 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1577 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1578 @code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1579 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1580 is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1581 @end defmac
1582
1583 @defmac SF_SIZE
1584 @defmacx DF_SIZE
1585 @defmacx XF_SIZE
1586 @defmacx TF_SIZE
1587 Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1588 @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1589 if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1590 @code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1591 for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1592 @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1593 @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1594 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1595 @end defmac
1596
1597 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1598 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1599 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1600 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1601 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1602 @end defmac
1603
1604 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1605 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1606 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1607 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1608 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1609 is the default.
1610 @end defmac
1611
1612 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1613 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1614 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1615 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1616 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1617 @end defmac
1618
1619 @hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1620 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1621 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1622 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1623 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1624
1625 The default is to return false.
1626 @end deftypefn
1627
1628 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1629 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1630 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1631 contents of the string.
1632
1633 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1634 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1635 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1636 of the data type names defined in the function
1637 @code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1638 omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1639 crash on startup.
1640
1641 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1642 int"}.
1643 @end defmac
1644
1645 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1646 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1647 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1648 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1649 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1650
1651 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1652 @end defmac
1653
1654 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1655 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1656 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1657 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1658 information.
1659
1660 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1661 @end defmac
1662
1663 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1664 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1665 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1666 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1667 @end defmac
1668
1669 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1670 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1671 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1672 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1673 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1674 information.
1675
1676 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1677 @end defmac
1678
1679 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1680 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1681 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1682 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1683 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1684
1685 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1686 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1687 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1688 @end defmac
1689
1690 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1691 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1692 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1693 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1694 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1695
1696 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1697 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1698 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1699 int}.
1700 @end defmac
1701
1702 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1703 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1704 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1705 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1706 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1707 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1708 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1709 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1710 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1711 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1712 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1713 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1714 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1715 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1716 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1717 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1718 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1719 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1720 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1721 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1722 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1723 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1724 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1725 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1726 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1727 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1728 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1729 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1730 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1731 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1732 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1733 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1734 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1735 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1736 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1737 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1738 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1739
1740 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1741 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1742 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1743 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1744 these macros are null pointers.
1745 @end defmac
1746
1747 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1748 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1749 that looks like:
1750
1751 @smallexample
1752 struct @{
1753 union @{
1754 void (*fn)();
1755 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1756 @};
1757 ptrdiff_t delta;
1758 @};
1759 @end smallexample
1760
1761 @noindent
1762 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1763 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1764 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1765 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1766 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1767 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1768 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1769 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1770
1771 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1772 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1773 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1774 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1775 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1776 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1777 architecture, you should define this macro to
1778 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1779
1780 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1781 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1782 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1783 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1784 @end defmac
1785
1786 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1787 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1788 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1789 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1790 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1791 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1792 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1793
1794 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1795 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1796 @end defmac
1797
1798 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1799 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1800 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1801 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1802 when special alignment is necessary. */
1803 @end defmac
1804
1805 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1806 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1807 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1808 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1809 of words in each data entry.
1810 @end defmac
1811
1812 @node Registers
1813 @section Register Usage
1814 @cindex register usage
1815
1816 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1817 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1818
1819 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1820 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1821 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1822 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1823 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1824
1825 @menu
1826 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1827 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1828 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1829 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1830 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1831 @end menu
1832
1833 @node Register Basics
1834 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1835
1836 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1837 Registers have various characteristics.
1838
1839 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1840 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1841 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1842 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1843 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1844 @end defmac
1845
1846 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1847 @cindex fixed register
1848 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1849 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1850 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1851 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1852 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1853 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1854 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1855
1856 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1857 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1858 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1859
1860 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1861 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1862 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1863 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1864 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1865 @end defmac
1866
1867 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1868 @cindex call-used register
1869 @cindex call-clobbered register
1870 @cindex call-saved register
1871 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1872 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1873 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1874 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1875 function calls.
1876
1877 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1878 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1879 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1880 @end defmac
1881
1882 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1883 @cindex call-used register
1884 @cindex call-clobbered register
1885 @cindex call-saved register
1886 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1887 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1888 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1889 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1890 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1891 @end defmac
1892
1893 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1894 @cindex call-used register
1895 @cindex call-clobbered register
1896 @cindex call-saved register
1897 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1898 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1899 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1900 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1901 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1902 @end defmac
1903
1904 @findex fixed_regs
1905 @findex call_used_regs
1906 @findex global_regs
1907 @findex reg_names
1908 @findex reg_class_contents
1909 @hook TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1910 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1911 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1912 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1913 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1914 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1915 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1916 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1917 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1918 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1919 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1920 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1921 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1922 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1923 command options have been applied.
1924
1925 @cindex disabling certain registers
1926 @cindex controlling register usage
1927 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1928 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1929 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1930 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1931 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1932 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1933 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1934
1935 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1936 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1937 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1938 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1939 @end deftypefn
1940
1941 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1942 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1943 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1944 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1945 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1946 outbound register.
1947 @end defmac
1948
1949 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1950 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1951 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1952 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1953 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1954 register.
1955 @end defmac
1956
1957 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1958 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1959 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1960 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1961 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1962 gotos.
1963 @end defmac
1964
1965 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1966 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1967 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1968 @end defmac
1969
1970 @node Allocation Order
1971 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1972 @cindex order of register allocation
1973 @cindex register allocation order
1974
1975 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1976 Registers are allocated in order.
1977
1978 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1979 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1980 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1981 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1982
1983 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1984 (all else being equal).
1985
1986 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1987 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1988 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1989 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1990 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1991 @end defmac
1992
1993 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1994 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1995 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1996
1997 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1998 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1999 register; and so on.
2000
2001 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2002 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2003
2004 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2005 @end defmac
2006
2007 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2008 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2009 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2010 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2011 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2012 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2013 should be defined.
2014 @end defmac
2015
2016 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2017 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2018 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2019 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2020 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2021 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2022 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2023 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2024
2025 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2026 @end defmac
2027
2028 @node Values in Registers
2029 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2030
2031 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2032 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2033 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2034
2035 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2036 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2037 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2038 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2039 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2040 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2041
2042 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2043 definition of this macro is
2044
2045 @smallexample
2046 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2047 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2048 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2049 @end smallexample
2050 @end defmac
2051
2052 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2053 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2054 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2055 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2056 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2057 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2058 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2059
2060 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2061 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2062 nonzero.
2063
2064 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2065 @code{subreg_get_info}
2066 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2067 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2068 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2069 registers and so not be representable.
2070 @end defmac
2071
2072 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2073 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2074 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2075 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2076 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2077 @end defmac
2078
2079 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2080 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2081 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2082 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2083 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2084 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2085 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2086 @end defmac
2087
2088 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2089 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2090 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2091 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2092 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2093
2094 @smallexample
2095 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2096 @end smallexample
2097
2098 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2099 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2100
2101 @cindex register pairs
2102 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2103 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2104 odd register numbers for such modes.
2105
2106 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2107 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2108 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2109 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2110
2111 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2112 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2113 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2114 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2115 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2116 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2117 to be tieable.
2118
2119 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2120 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2121 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2122 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2123 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2124 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2125
2126 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2127 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2128 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2129 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2130 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2131 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2132 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2133 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2134 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2135
2136 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2137 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2138 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2139 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2140 constraints for those instructions.
2141
2142 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2143 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2144 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2145 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2146 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2147 @end defmac
2148
2149 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2150 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2151 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2152
2153 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2154 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2155 handler.
2156
2157 The default is always nonzero.
2158 @end defmac
2159
2160 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2161 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2162 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2163
2164 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2165 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2166 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2167 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2168 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2169 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2170
2171 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2172 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2173 allocation.
2174 @end defmac
2175
2176 @hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2177 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2178 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2179
2180 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2181 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2182
2183 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2184 @end deftypefn
2185
2186 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2187 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2188 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2189 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2190 @end defmac
2191
2192 @node Leaf Functions
2193 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2194
2195 @cindex leaf functions
2196 @cindex functions, leaf
2197 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2198 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2199 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2200 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2201 normally arrive.
2202
2203 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2204 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2205 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2206 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2207 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2208 functions''.
2209
2210 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2211 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2212 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2213 accomplish this.
2214
2215 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2216 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2217 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2218 function treatment.
2219
2220 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2221 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2222 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2223 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2224 in this vector.
2225
2226 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2227 the treatment of leaf functions.
2228 @end defmac
2229
2230 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2231 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2232 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2233
2234 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2235 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2236 will cause the compiler to abort.
2237
2238 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2239 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2240 this.
2241 @end defmac
2242
2243 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2244 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2245 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2246 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2247 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2248 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2249 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2250 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2251 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2252 functions which only use leaf registers.
2253 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2254 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2255 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2256 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2257 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2258
2259 @node Stack Registers
2260 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2261
2262 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2263 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2264 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2265 stack.
2266
2267 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2268 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2269 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2270 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2271 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2272 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2273 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2274
2275 @defmac STACK_REGS
2276 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2277 @end defmac
2278
2279 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2280 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2281 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2282 @end defmac
2283
2284 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2285 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2286 of the stack.
2287 @end defmac
2288
2289 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2290 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2291 the stack.
2292 @end defmac
2293
2294 @node Register Classes
2295 @section Register Classes
2296 @cindex register class definitions
2297 @cindex class definitions, register
2298
2299 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2300 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2301 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2302 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2303
2304 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2305 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2306 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2307
2308 @findex ALL_REGS
2309 @findex NO_REGS
2310 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2311 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2312 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2313 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2314
2315 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2316 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2317 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2318 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2319 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2320 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2321
2322 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2323 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2324
2325 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2326 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2327 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2328 them in operand constraints.
2329
2330 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2331 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2332 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2333 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2334 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2335
2336 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2337 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2338 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2339 in their union.
2340
2341 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2342 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2343 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2344 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2345 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2346
2347 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2348 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2349 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2350 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2351 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2352 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2353 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2354 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2355 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2356
2357 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2358 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2359 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2360 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2361 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2362 tells how many classes there are.
2363
2364 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2365 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2366 in many of the tables described below.
2367 @end deftp
2368
2369 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2370 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2371
2372 @smallexample
2373 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2374 @end smallexample
2375 @end defmac
2376
2377 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2378 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2379 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2380 @end defmac
2381
2382 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2383 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2384 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2385 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2386 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2387
2388 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2389 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2390 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2391 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2392 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2393 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2394 so on.
2395 @end defmac
2396
2397 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2398 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2399 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2400 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2401 register.
2402 @end defmac
2403
2404 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2405 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2406 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2407 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2408 @end defmac
2409
2410 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2411 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2412 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2413 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2414 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2415 @end defmac
2416
2417 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2418 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2419 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2420 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2421 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2422 @end defmac
2423
2424 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2425 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2426 base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2427 context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2428 the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2429 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2430 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2431 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2432 @end defmac
2433
2434 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2435 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2436 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2437 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2438 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2439 @end defmac
2440
2441 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2442 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2443 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2444 @end defmac
2445
2446 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2447 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2448 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2449 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2450 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2451 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2452 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2453 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2454 @code{address_operand}.
2455 @end defmac
2456
2457 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2458 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2459 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2460 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2461 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2462 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2463 than other base register uses.
2464
2465 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2466 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2467 @end defmac
2468
2469 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2470 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2471 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2472 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2473 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2474 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2475 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2476 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2477 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2478 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2479 @end defmac
2480
2481 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2482 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2483 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2484 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2485 allocated such a hard register.
2486
2487 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2488 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2489 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2490 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2491 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2492 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2493 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2494 only if neither labeling works.
2495 @end defmac
2496
2497 @hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2498 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2499 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2500 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2501 another, smaller class.
2502
2503 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2504
2505 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2506 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2507 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2508 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2509 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2510
2511 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2512 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2513 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2514 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2515 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2516 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2517 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2518 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2519 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2520 @code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2521 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2522
2523 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2524 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2525 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2526 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2527 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2528 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2529 @end deftypefn
2530
2531 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2532 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2533 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2534 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2535 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2536 safe:
2537
2538 @smallexample
2539 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2540 @end smallexample
2541
2542 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2543 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2544 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2545 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2546 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2547
2548 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2549 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2550 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2551 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2552 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2553 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2554 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2555 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2556 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2557 @code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2558 of using @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2559
2560 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2561 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2562 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2563 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2564 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2565 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2566 @end defmac
2567
2568 @defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2569 Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2570 input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2571 @var{class}, unchanged.
2572
2573 You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2574 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2575 @end defmac
2576
2577 @hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2578 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2579 input reloads.
2580
2581 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2582 argument.
2583
2584 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2585 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2586 @end deftypefn
2587
2588 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2589 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2590 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2591 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2592 ordinarily be used.
2593
2594 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2595 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2596
2597 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2598 smaller class.
2599
2600 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2601 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2602 @end defmac
2603
2604 @hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2605 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2606 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2607 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2608 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2609 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2610 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2611 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2612 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2613 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2614 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2615 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2616 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2617
2618 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2619 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2620 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2621 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2622 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2623 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2624 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2625 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2626 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2627 of the scratch register(s).
2628
2629 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2630
2631 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2632 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2633 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2634 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2635 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2636
2637 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2638 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2639 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2640 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2641 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2642 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2643
2644 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2645 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2646 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2647 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2648 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2649
2650 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2651 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2652 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2653 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2654 single-register-class
2655 @c [later: or memory]
2656 output constraint.
2657
2658 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2659 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2660 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2661 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2662
2663 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2664 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2665 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2666 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2667 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2668 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2669 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2670 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2671
2672
2673 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2674 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2675 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2676 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2677
2678 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2679 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2680 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2681
2682 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2683 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2684 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2685 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2686 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2687 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2688 @end deftypefn
2689
2690 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2691 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2692 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2693 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2694 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2695
2696 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2697 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2698 reload phase that it may
2699 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2700 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2701 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2702 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2703 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2704 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2705
2706 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2707 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2708 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2709 class required. If the
2710 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2711 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2712 macros identically.
2713
2714 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2715 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2716 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2717 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2718 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2719
2720 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2721 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2722 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2723 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2724 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2725 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2726 register.
2727
2728 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2729 register that
2730 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2731 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2732 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2733 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2734 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2735
2736 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2737 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2738 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2739 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2740
2741 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2742 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2743 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2744 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2745 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2746 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2747 general registers.
2748 @end defmac
2749
2750 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2751 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2752 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2753 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2754 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2755 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2756 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2757
2758 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2759 @end defmac
2760
2761 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2762 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2763 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2764 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2765 defined by this macro.
2766
2767 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2768 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2769 @end defmac
2770
2771 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2772 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2773 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2774 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2775 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2776 same as that of @var{mode}.
2777
2778 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2779 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2780 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2781 registers.
2782
2783 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2784 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2785 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2786 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2787 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2788 details.
2789
2790 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2791 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2792 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2793 @end defmac
2794
2795 @hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2796 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2797 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2798 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2799
2800 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2801 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2802 default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2803 if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2804 hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2805 @code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2806 @file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2807 register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2808 you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2809 the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2810 allocation.
2811 @end deftypefn
2812
2813 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2814 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2815 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2816
2817 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2818 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2819 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2820 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2821
2822 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2823 in the reload pass.
2824 @end defmac
2825
2826 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2827 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2828 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2829
2830 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2831 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2832 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2833 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2834 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2835 as below:
2836
2837 @smallexample
2838 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2839 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2840 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2841 @end smallexample
2842 @end defmac
2843
2844 @hook TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2845 Return an array of cover classes for the Integrated Register Allocator
2846 (@acronym{IRA}). Cover classes are a set of non-intersecting register
2847 classes covering all hard registers used for register allocation
2848 purposes. If a move between two registers in the same cover class is
2849 possible, it should be cheaper than a load or store of the registers.
2850 The array is terminated by a @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES} element.
2851
2852 The order of cover classes in the array is important. If two classes
2853 have the same cost of usage for a pseudo, the class occurred first in
2854 the array is chosen for the pseudo.
2855
2856 This hook is called once at compiler startup, after the command-line
2857 options have been processed. It is then re-examined by every call to
2858 @code{target_reinit}.
2859
2860 The default implementation returns @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES}, if defined,
2861 otherwise there is no default implementation. You must define either this
2862 macro or @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES} in order to use the integrated register
2863 allocator with Chaitin-Briggs coloring. If the macro is not defined,
2864 the only available coloring algorithm is Chow's priority coloring.
2865
2866 This hook must not be modified from @code{NULL} to non-@code{NULL} or
2867 vice versa by command-line option processing.
2868 @end deftypefn
2869
2870 @defmac IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2871 See the documentation for @code{TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES}.
2872 @end defmac
2873
2874 @node Old Constraints
2875 @section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2876 @cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2877 @cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2878
2879 Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2880 of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2881 Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2882 it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2883
2884 @defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2885 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2886 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2887 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2888 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2889 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2890 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2891 to handle specially.
2892 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2893 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2894 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2895 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2896 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2897 @end defmac
2898
2899 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2900 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2901 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2902 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2903 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2904 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2905 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2906 @end defmac
2907
2908 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2909 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2910 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2911 different variants.
2912 @end defmac
2913
2914 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2915 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2916 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2917 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2918 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2919 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2920 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2921 @var{value}.
2922 @end defmac
2923
2924 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2925 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2926 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2927 between different variants.
2928 @end defmac
2929
2930 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2931 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2932 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2933 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2934
2935 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2936 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2937 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2938 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2939
2940 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2941 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2942 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2943 between these kinds.
2944 @end defmac
2945
2946 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2947 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2948 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2949 between different variants.
2950 @end defmac
2951
2952 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2953 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2954 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2955 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2956 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2957 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2958 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2959
2960 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2961 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2962 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2963 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2964
2965 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2966 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2967 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2968 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2969 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2970 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2971 does not include r0 on the output.
2972 @end defmac
2973
2974 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2975 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2976 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2977 variants.
2978 @end defmac
2979
2980 @defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2981 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2982 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2983 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2984
2985 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2986 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2987 comprises a subset of all memory references including
2988 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2989 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2990 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2991
2992 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2993 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2994 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2995 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2996 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2997 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2998 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2999 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
3000 an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
3001 @end defmac
3002
3003 @defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3004 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3005 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3006 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3007 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3008
3009 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3010 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3011 a subset of all memory addresses including
3012 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3013 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3014 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3015
3016 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3017 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3018 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3019 @end defmac
3020
3021 @node Stack and Calling
3022 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3023 @cindex calling conventions
3024
3025 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3026 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3027
3028 @menu
3029 * Frame Layout::
3030 * Exception Handling::
3031 * Stack Checking::
3032 * Frame Registers::
3033 * Elimination::
3034 * Stack Arguments::
3035 * Register Arguments::
3036 * Scalar Return::
3037 * Aggregate Return::
3038 * Caller Saves::
3039 * Function Entry::
3040 * Profiling::
3041 * Tail Calls::
3042 * Stack Smashing Protection::
3043 @end menu
3044
3045 @node Frame Layout
3046 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
3047 @cindex stack frame layout
3048 @cindex frame layout
3049
3050 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3051 Here is the basic stack layout.
3052
3053 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3054 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3055 pointer to a smaller address.
3056
3057 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3058 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3059 definition used does not matter.
3060 @end defmac
3061
3062 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3063 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3064 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3065 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3066
3067 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3068 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3069 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3070 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3071 space for the next item on the stack.
3072
3073 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3074 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3075 which is often wrong.
3076 @end defmac
3077
3078 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3079 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3080 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3081 @end defmac
3082
3083 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3084 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3085 addresses on the stack.
3086 @end defmac
3087
3088 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3089 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3090
3091 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3092 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3093 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3094 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3095 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3096 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3097 @end defmac
3098
3099 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3100 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3101 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3102
3103 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3104 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3105 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3106 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3107 @end defmac
3108
3109 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3110 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3111 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3112 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3113
3114 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3115 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3116 @end defmac
3117
3118 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3119 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3120 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3121 function.
3122
3123 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3124 the first argument's address.
3125 @end defmac
3126
3127 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3128 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3129 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3130
3131 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3132 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3133 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3134 @end defmac
3135
3136 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3137 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3138 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3139 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3140 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3141 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3142 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3143 @end defmac
3144
3145 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3146 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3147 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3148 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3149 itself.
3150
3151 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3152 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3153 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3154 @end defmac
3155
3156 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3157 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3158 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3159 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3160 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3161 define this macro.
3162 @end defmac
3163
3164 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3165 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3166 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3167 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3168 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3169 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3170 @end deftypefn
3171
3172 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3173 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3174 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3175 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3176 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3177 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3178 @end defmac
3179
3180 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3181 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3182 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3183 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3184 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3185 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3186
3187 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3188 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3189 determine the return address of other frames.
3190 @end defmac
3191
3192 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3193 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3194 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3195 @end defmac
3196
3197 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3198 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3199 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3200 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3201 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3202 the stack.
3203
3204 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3205 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3206
3207 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3208 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3209 @end defmac
3210
3211 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3212 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3213 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3214 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3215 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3216
3217 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3218 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3219 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3220 over time.
3221 @end defmac
3222
3223 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3224 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3225 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3226 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3227 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3228 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3229 @end defmac
3230
3231 @hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3232 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3233 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3234 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3235 @smallexample
3236 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3237 @end smallexample
3238 and
3239 @smallexample
3240 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3241 @end smallexample
3242 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3243 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3244 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3245 @end deftypefn
3246
3247 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3248 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3249 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3250 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3251 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3252 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3253
3254 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3255 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3256 @end defmac
3257
3258 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3259 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3260 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3261 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3262 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3263 during virtual register instantiation.
3264
3265 The default value for this macro is
3266 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3267 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3268 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3269 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3270 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3271
3272 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3273 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3274 DWARF 2.
3275 @end defmac
3276
3277 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3278 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3279 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3280 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3281 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3282
3283 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3284 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3285 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3286 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3287 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3288 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3289 should be defined.
3290 @end defmac
3291
3292 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3293 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3294 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3295 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3296 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3297 @end defmac
3298
3299 @node Exception Handling
3300 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3301 @cindex exception handling
3302
3303 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3304 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3305 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3306 @var{N} registers are usable.
3307
3308 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3309 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3310 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3311 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3312 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3313
3314 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3315 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3316 @end defmac
3317
3318 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3319 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3320 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3321 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3322 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3323
3324 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3325 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3326
3327 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3328 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3329 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3330 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3331 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3332 that provided by DWARF 2.
3333 @end defmac
3334
3335 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3336 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3337 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3338 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3339
3340 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3341 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3342 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3343 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3344 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3345 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3346 target call frame.
3347
3348 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3349 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3350 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3351
3352 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3353 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3354 @end defmac
3355
3356 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3357 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3358 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3359 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3360 using it to return to the exception handler.
3361 @end defmac
3362
3363 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3364 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3365 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3366 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3367 and so may be read-only.
3368
3369 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3370 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3371 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3372 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3373
3374 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3375 represented directly.
3376 @end defmac
3377
3378 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3379 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3380 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3381 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3382 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3383
3384 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3385 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3386 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3387 to be emitted.
3388 @end defmac
3389
3390 @defmac MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT
3391 A string specifying a file to be #include'd in unwind-dw2.c. The file
3392 so included typically defines @code{MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR}.
3393 @end defmac
3394
3395 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3396 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3397 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3398 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3399 through signal frames.
3400
3401 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3402 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3403 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3404 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3405 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3406 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3407 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3408 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3409 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3410
3411 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3412 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3413 @end defmac
3414
3415 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3416 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3417 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3418 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3419
3420 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3421 @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3422 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3423 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3424 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3425 be updated in @var{fs}.
3426 @end defmac
3427
3428 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3429 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3430 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3431 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3432 @end defmac
3433
3434 @node Stack Checking
3435 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3436
3437 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3438 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3439 three ways:
3440
3441 @enumerate
3442 @item
3443 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3444 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3445 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3446 other special processing.
3447
3448 @item
3449 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3450 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3451 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3452 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3453 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3454 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3455 approach below.
3456
3457 @item
3458 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3459 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3460 @end enumerate
3461
3462 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3463 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3464 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3465 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3466
3467 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3468 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3469 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3470 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3471 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3472 value of this macro is zero.
3473 @end defmac
3474
3475 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3476 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3477 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3478 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3479 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3480 @end defmac
3481
3482 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3483 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3484 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3485 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3486 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3487 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3488 @end defmac
3489
3490 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3491 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3492 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3493 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3494 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3495 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3496 default value of this macro is zero.
3497 @end defmac
3498
3499 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3500 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3501 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3502 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3503 8192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3504 most machines.
3505 @end defmac
3506
3507 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3508 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3509 in the opposite case.
3510
3511 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3512 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3513 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3514 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3515 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3516 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3517 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3518 @end defmac
3519
3520 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3521 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3522 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3523 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3524 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3525 use the default of four words.
3526 @end defmac
3527
3528 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3529 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3530 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3531 @option{-fstack-check}.
3532 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3533 normally not need to override that default.
3534 @end defmac
3535
3536 @need 2000
3537 @node Frame Registers
3538 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3539
3540 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3541 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3542
3543 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3544 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3545 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3546 the hardware determines which register this is.
3547 @end defmac
3548
3549 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3550 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3551 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3552 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3553 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3554 @end defmac
3555
3556 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3557 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3558 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3559 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3560 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3561 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3562 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3563 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3564 used for the frame pointer.
3565
3566 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3567 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3568 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3569 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3570 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3571 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3572 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3573
3574 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3575 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3576 @end defmac
3577
3578 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3579 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3580 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3581 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3582 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3583 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3584 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3585 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3586 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3587 @end defmac
3588
3589 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3590 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3591 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3592 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3593 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3594 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3595 @end defmac
3596
3597 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3598 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3599 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3600 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3601 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3602 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3603 @end defmac
3604
3605 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3606 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3607 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3608 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3609 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3610 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3611 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3612
3613 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3614 address from the stack.
3615 @end defmac
3616
3617 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3618 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3619 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3620 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3621 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3622 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3623 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3624 not be defined.
3625
3626 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3627
3628 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3629 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3630 @end defmac
3631
3632 @hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3633 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3634 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3635 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3636 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3637 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3638
3639 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3640
3641 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3642 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3643 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3644 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3645 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3646 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3647 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3648 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3649 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3650 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3651 to refer to those items.
3652 @end deftypefn
3653
3654 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3655 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3656 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3657 DWARF2 exception handling.
3658
3659 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3660 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3661 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3662 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3663 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3664 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3665 registers that are not call-saved.
3666
3667 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3668 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3669 @end defmac
3670
3671 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3672
3673 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3674 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3675
3676 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3677 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3678 @end defmac
3679
3680 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3681
3682 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3683 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3684 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3685 column number to use instead.
3686
3687 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3688 @end defmac
3689
3690 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3691
3692 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3693 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3694 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3695 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3696 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3697
3698 @end defmac
3699
3700 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3701
3702 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3703 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3704 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3705 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3706 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3707
3708 @end defmac
3709
3710 @node Elimination
3711 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3712
3713 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3714 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3715
3716 @hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3717 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3718 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3719 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3720
3721 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3722 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3723 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3724 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3725 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3726 pointer.
3727
3728 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3729 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3730 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3731 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3732 them.
3733
3734 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3735 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3736 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3737
3738 Default return value is @code{false}.
3739 @end deftypefn
3740
3741 @findex get_frame_size
3742 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3743 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3744 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3745 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3746 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3747 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3748
3749 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3750 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3751 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3752 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3753 @end defmac
3754
3755 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3756 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3757 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3758 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3759 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3760
3761 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3762 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3763
3764 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3765 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3766 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3767 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3768 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3769
3770 In this case, you might specify:
3771 @smallexample
3772 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3773 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3774 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3775 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3776 @end smallexample
3777
3778 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3779 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3780 @end defmac
3781
3782 @hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3783 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3784 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3785 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3786 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3787 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3788 knows about.
3789
3790 Default return value is @code{true}.
3791 @end deftypefn
3792
3793 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3794 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3795 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3796 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3797 defined.
3798 @end defmac
3799
3800 @node Stack Arguments
3801 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3802 @cindex arguments on stack
3803 @cindex stack arguments
3804
3805 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3806 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3807 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3808
3809 @hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3810 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3811 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3812 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3813 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3814 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3815 @end deftypefn
3816
3817 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3818 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3819 outgoing arguments.
3820 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3821 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3822 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3823 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3824 @end defmac
3825
3826 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3827 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3828 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3829 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3830 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3831 @end defmac
3832
3833 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3834 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3835 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3836
3837 On some machines, the definition
3838
3839 @smallexample
3840 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3841 @end smallexample
3842
3843 @noindent
3844 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3845 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3846 alignment. Then the definition should be
3847
3848 @smallexample
3849 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3850 @end smallexample
3851
3852 It the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3853 @end defmac
3854
3855 @findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3856 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3857 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3858 will be computed and placed into the variable
3859 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3860 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3861 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3862
3863 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3864 is not proper.
3865 @end defmac
3866
3867 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3868 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3869 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3870 registers.
3871
3872 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3873 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3874 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3875 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3876 of the function.
3877
3878 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3879 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3880 which.
3881 @end defmac
3882 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3883 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3884
3885 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3886 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3887 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3888 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3889 if the function called is a library function.
3890
3891 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3892 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3893 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3894 @end defmac
3895
3896 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3897 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3898 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3899 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3900 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3901
3902 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3903 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3904 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3905 stack in its natural location.
3906 @end defmac
3907
3908 @hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
3909 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3910 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3911 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3912
3913 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3914 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3915 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3916 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3917
3918 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3919 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3920 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3921 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3922 arguments (if known).
3923
3924 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3925 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3926 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3927 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3928 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3929 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3930
3931 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3932 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3933 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3934
3935 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3936 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3937 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3938 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3939 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3940 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3941 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3942 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3943 number of arguments.
3944 @end deftypefn
3945
3946 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3947 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3948 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3949 when compiling a function call.
3950
3951 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3952 have been accumulated.
3953
3954 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3955 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3956 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3957 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3958 appropriate.
3959 @end defmac
3960
3961 @node Register Arguments
3962 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3963 @cindex arguments in registers
3964 @cindex registers arguments
3965
3966 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3967 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3968 the stack.
3969
3970 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3971 A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
3972 in a register, and which register.
3973
3974 The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
3975 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3976 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3977 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3978 which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
3979 correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
3980 @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
3981 occurred.
3982
3983 The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
3984 hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
3985 argument on the stack.
3986
3987 For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
3988 pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
3989
3990 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3991 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3992 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3993 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3994 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3995 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3996 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3997 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3998 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3999 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4000 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4001 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4002 argument is also stored on the stack.
4003
4004 The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4005 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4006 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4007
4008 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4009 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
4010 where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
4011 nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
4012 by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
4013
4014 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4015 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4016 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4017 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4018 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4019 is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4020 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4021 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4022 a register.
4023 @end defmac
4024
4025 @hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4026 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4027 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4028 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4029 documentation.
4030 @end deftypefn
4031
4032 @defmac FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4033 Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4034 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4035 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4036 argument.
4037
4038 For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
4039 the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
4040 be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
4041 where the arguments will arrive.
4042
4043 If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4044 serves both purposes.
4045 @end defmac
4046
4047 @hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4048 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4049 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4050 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4051 pushed on the stack.
4052
4053 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4054 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4055 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4056 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4057 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4058 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4059 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4060
4061 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4062 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4063 @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4064 @end deftypefn
4065
4066 @hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
4067 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4068 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4069 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4070 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4071
4072 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4073 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4074 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4075 to that type.
4076 @end deftypefn
4077
4078 @hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4079 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4080 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4081 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4082 by the caller.
4083
4084 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4085 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4086 not be generated.
4087
4088 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4089 @end deftypefn
4090
4091 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4092 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
4093 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
4094 the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
4095 argument so far.
4096
4097 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4098 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4099 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4100 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4101 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4102 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4103 @end defmac
4104
4105 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4106 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4107 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4108 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4109 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4110 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4111 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4112 @end defmac
4113
4114 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4115 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4116 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4117 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4118 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4119 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4120 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4121 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4122 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4123 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4124 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4125 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4126 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4127
4128 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4129 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4130 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4131 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4132 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4133 never both of them at once.
4134 @end defmac
4135
4136 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4137 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4138 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4139 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4140 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4141 0)} is used instead.
4142 @end defmac
4143
4144 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4145 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4146 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4147 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4148
4149 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4150 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4151 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4152 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4153 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4154 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4155 @end defmac
4156
4157 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4158 A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
4159 @var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
4160 values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
4161 Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
4162 the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4163
4164 This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4165 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4166 used for arguments without any special help.
4167 @end defmac
4168
4169 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4170 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4171 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4172 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4173 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4174 top.
4175 @end defmac
4176
4177 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4178 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4179 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4180 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4181 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4182
4183 The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
4184 multiple of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not
4185 control it.
4186
4187 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4188 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4189 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4190 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4191 @end defmac
4192
4193 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4194 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4195 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4196 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4197 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4198 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4199 @end defmac
4200
4201 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4202 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4203 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4204 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4205 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4206 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4207 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4208 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4209 required.
4210 @end defmac
4211
4212 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
4213 This hook returns the the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4214 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4215 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4216 @end deftypefn
4217
4218 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4219 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4220 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4221 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4222 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4223 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4224 stack.
4225 @end defmac
4226
4227 @hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4228 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4229 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4230 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4231 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4232 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4233 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4234 point register.
4235
4236 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4237 false.
4238 @end deftypefn
4239
4240 @hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4241 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4242 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4243 @end deftypefn
4244
4245 @hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
4246 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4247 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4248 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4249 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4250 variable.
4251 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4252 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4253 internal type.
4254 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4255 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4256 macro to iterate through all types.
4257 @end deftypefn
4258
4259 @hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4260 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4261 @var{fndecl}.
4262 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4263 @end deftypefn
4264
4265 @hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4266 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4267 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4268 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4269 @end deftypefn
4270
4271 @hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4272 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4273 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4274 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4275 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4276 @end deftypefn
4277
4278 @hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4279 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4280 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4281 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4282 @end deftypefn
4283
4284 @hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4285 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4286 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4287 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4288 must work.
4289
4290 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4291 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4292 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4293 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4294 @end deftypefn
4295
4296 @hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4297 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4298 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4299 must have move patterns for this mode.
4300 @end deftypefn
4301
4302 @hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4303 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4304 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4305 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4306 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4307 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4308 for any mode.
4309
4310 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4311 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4312 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4313 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4314 insn.
4315
4316 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4317 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4318 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4319 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4320 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4321 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4322 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4323 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4324 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4325
4326 The default version of this hook retuns false for any mode. It is always
4327 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4328 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4329 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4330 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4331 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4332 @end deftypefn
4333
4334 @node Scalar Return
4335 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4336 @cindex return values in registers
4337 @cindex values, returned by functions
4338 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4339
4340 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4341 values---values that can fit in registers.
4342
4343 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4344
4345 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4346 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4347 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4348 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4349 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4350 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4351 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4352 a function returns a value.
4353
4354 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4355 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4356 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4357 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4358 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4359 multiple places. See @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4360 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4361 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4362 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4363 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4364 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4365 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4366
4367 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4368 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4369 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4370
4371 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4372 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4373 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4374 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4375 known.
4376
4377 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4378 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4379 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4380 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4381
4382 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4383 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4384 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4385 @end deftypefn
4386
4387 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4388 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4389 a new target instead.
4390 @end defmac
4391
4392 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4393 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4394 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4395
4396 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4397 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4398 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4399 compiled.
4400 @end defmac
4401
4402 @hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4403 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4404 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4405
4406 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4407 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4408 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4409
4410 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4411 @end deftypefn
4412
4413 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4414 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4415 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4416
4417 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4418 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4419 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4420 suffices:
4421
4422 @smallexample
4423 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4424 @end smallexample
4425
4426 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4427 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4428 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4429
4430 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4431 for a new target instead.
4432 @end defmac
4433
4434 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4435 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4436 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4437
4438 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4439 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4440 recognized by this target hook.
4441
4442 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4443 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4444 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4445
4446 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4447 @end deftypefn
4448
4449 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4450 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4451 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4452 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4453 @end defmac
4454
4455 @hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4456 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4457 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4458 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4459 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4460
4461 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4462 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4463 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4464 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4465 @code{SImode} rtx.
4466 @end deftypefn
4467
4468 @node Aggregate Return
4469 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4470 @cindex aggregates as return values
4471 @cindex large return values
4472 @cindex returning aggregate values
4473 @cindex structure value address
4474
4475 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4476 cases), the value is not returned according to
4477 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4478 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4479 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4480 address}.
4481
4482 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4483 memory.
4484
4485 @hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4486 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4487 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4488 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4489 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4490 libcalls.
4491
4492 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4493 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4494 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4495 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4496 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4497 values, and 0 otherwise.
4498
4499 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4500 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4501 to indicate this.
4502 @end deftypefn
4503
4504 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4505 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4506 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4507 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4508 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4509 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4510 target hook.
4511
4512 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4513 @end defmac
4514
4515 @hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4516 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4517 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4518 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4519 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4520 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4521 argument.
4522
4523 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4524 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4525 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4526 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4527 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4528 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4529 the caller.
4530
4531 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4532 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4533 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4534 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4535 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4536 @end deftypefn
4537
4538 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4539 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4540 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4541 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4542
4543 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4544 pass an address to the subroutine.
4545
4546 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4547 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4548 @end defmac
4549
4550 @hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
4551
4552 @hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
4553
4554 @node Caller Saves
4555 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4556
4557 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4558 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4559 must live across calls.
4560
4561 @defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4562 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4563 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4564 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4565 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4566
4567 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4568 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4569 @end defmac
4570
4571 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4572 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4573 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4574 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4575 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4576 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4577 @end defmac
4578
4579 @node Function Entry
4580 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4581 @cindex function entry and exit
4582 @cindex prologue
4583 @cindex epilogue
4584
4585 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4586 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4587
4588 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4589 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4590 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4591 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4592 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4593 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4594 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4595
4596 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4597 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4598
4599 @findex regs_ever_live
4600 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4601 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4602 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4603 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4604 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4605 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4606
4607 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4608 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4609 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4610 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4611 registers are used in the function.
4612
4613 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4614 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4615 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4616 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4617 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4618 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4619 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4620
4621 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4622 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4623 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4624 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4625 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4626 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4627 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4628 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4629 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4630 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4631 @end deftypefn
4632
4633 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4634 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4635 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4636 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4637 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4638 @end deftypefn
4639
4640 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4641 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4642 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4643 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4644 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4645 @end deftypefn
4646
4647 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4648 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4649 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4650 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4651 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4652 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4653 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4654 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4655
4656 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4657 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4658 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4659 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4660
4661 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4662 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4663 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4664 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4665 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4666 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4667
4668 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4669 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4670 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4671 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4672 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4673 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4674
4675 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4676 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4677 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4678 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4679
4680 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4681 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4682 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4683 number of arguments.
4684
4685 @findex current_function_pops_args
4686 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4687 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4688 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4689 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4690 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4691 @end deftypefn
4692
4693 @itemize @bullet
4694 @item
4695 @findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4696 A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4697 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4698 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4699 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4700 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4701 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4702 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4703 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4704 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4705
4706 @item
4707 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4708 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4709 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4710 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4711 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4712 a save area.
4713
4714 @item
4715 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4716 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4717 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4718 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4719
4720 @item
4721 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4722 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4723 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4724 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4725 @end itemize
4726
4727 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4728 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4729 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4730 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4731 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4732 default is 0.
4733
4734 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4735 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4736 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4737 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4738 @end defmac
4739
4740 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4741 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4742 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4743 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4744 @end defmac
4745
4746 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4747 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4748 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4749 on entry to an exception edge.
4750 @end defmac
4751
4752 @defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4753 Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4754 instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4755 definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4756 representing the number of delay slots there.
4757 @end defmac
4758
4759 @defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4760 A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4761 slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4762
4763 The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4764 being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4765 eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4766 of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4767 If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4768 may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4769 (at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4770 slot.
4771
4772 @findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4773 @findex final_scan_insn
4774 The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4775 list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4776 @code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4777 delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4778 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4779 outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4780 @code{final_scan_insn}.
4781
4782 You need not define this macro if you did not define
4783 @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4784 @end defmac
4785
4786 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4787 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4788 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4789 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4790 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4791 the real function.
4792
4793 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4794 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4795 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4796 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4797 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4798 all other incoming arguments.
4799
4800 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4801 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4802 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4803
4804 @smallexample
4805 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4806 @end smallexample
4807
4808 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4809 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4810 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4811 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4812
4813 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4814 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4815 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4816 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4817
4818 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4819 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4820 some targets, but probably not.
4821
4822 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4823 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4824 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4825 not support varargs.
4826 @end deftypefn
4827
4828 @hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4829 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4830 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4831 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4832 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4833 previously exposed.
4834 @end deftypefn
4835
4836 @node Profiling
4837 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4838 @cindex profiling, code generation
4839
4840 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4841
4842 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4843 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4844 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4845
4846 @findex mcount
4847 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4848 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4849 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4850 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4851
4852 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4853 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4854 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4855 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4856 @end defmac
4857
4858 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4859 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4860 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4861 not support profiling.
4862 @end defmac
4863
4864 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4865 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4866 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4867 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4868 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4869 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4870 @end defmac
4871
4872 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4873 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4874 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4875 @end defmac
4876
4877 @node Tail Calls
4878 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4879 @cindex tail calls
4880
4881 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4882 True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4883 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4884 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4885
4886 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4887 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4888 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4889 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4890 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4891 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4892 @end deftypefn
4893
4894 @hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4895 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4896 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4897 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4898 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4899 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4900 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4901 @end deftypefn
4902
4903 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4904 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4905 @cindex stack smashing protection
4906
4907 @hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4908 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4909 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4910 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4911 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4912 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4913
4914 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4915 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4916 @end deftypefn
4917
4918 @hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
4919 This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4920 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4921 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4922
4923 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4924 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4925 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4926 @end deftypefn
4927
4928 @hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4929
4930 @node Varargs
4931 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4932 @cindex varargs implementation
4933
4934 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4935 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4936 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4937 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4938 conditionals to include it.
4939
4940 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4941 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4942 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4943 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4944 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4945 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4946
4947 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4948 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4949 below.
4950
4951 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4952 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4953 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4954 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4955 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4956
4957 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4958 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4959 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4960 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4961
4962 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4963 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4964 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4965 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4966 to use them for its own purposes.
4967 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4968 @c 10feb93
4969 @end defmac
4970
4971 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4972 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4973 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4974 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4975 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4976 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4977 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4978 of the current function.
4979 @end defmac
4980
4981 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4982 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4983 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4984 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4985 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4986 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4987
4988 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4989 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4990 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4991
4992 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4993 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4994 @end defmac
4995
4996 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4997
4998 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4999 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5000 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5001 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5002 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5003 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5004 @end deftypefn
5005
5006 @hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
5007 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5008 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5009 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5010 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5011 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5012 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5013 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5014
5015 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5016 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5017 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5018 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5019
5020 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5021 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5022 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5023 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5024 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5025 frame.
5026
5027 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5028 compile time without knowing their data types,
5029 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5030 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5031 for all data types.
5032
5033 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5034 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5035 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5036 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5037 not generate any instructions in this case.
5038 @end deftypefn
5039
5040 @hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5041 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5042 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5043
5044 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
5045 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5046 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5047 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5048 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5049 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5050 except the last are treated as named.
5051
5052 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5053 @end deftypefn
5054
5055 @hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5056 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5057 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5058 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5059 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5060 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5061 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5062 @end deftypefn
5063
5064 @node Trampolines
5065 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5066 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5067 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5068
5069 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5070 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5071 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5072 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5073 trampoline.
5074
5075 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5076 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5077 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5078 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5079 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5080 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5081 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5082 operands.
5083
5084 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5085 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5086 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5087 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5088 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5089 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5090 separately.
5091
5092 @hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5093 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5094 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5095 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5096 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5097
5098 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5099 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5100 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5101 to generate it on the spot.
5102 @end deftypefn
5103
5104 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5105 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5106 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5107 @end defmac
5108
5109 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5110 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5111 @end defmac
5112
5113 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5114 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5115
5116 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5117 is used for aligning trampolines.
5118 @end defmac
5119
5120 @hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5121 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5122 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5123 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5124 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5125 when it is called.
5126
5127 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5128 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5129 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5130 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5131 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5132 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5133
5134 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5135 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5136 initializing the trampoline proper.
5137 @end deftypefn
5138
5139 @hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5140 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5141 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5142 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5143 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5144 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5145 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5146 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5147 @end deftypefn
5148
5149 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5150 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5151 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5152 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5153
5154 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5155 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5156 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5157 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5158 latter makes initialization faster.
5159
5160 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5161 the following macro.
5162
5163 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5164 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5165 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5166 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5167 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5168 @end defmac
5169
5170 The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
5171 before calling the trampoline. To implement this requirement, define
5172 the following macro.
5173
5174 @defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
5175 Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
5176 code located on the stack. The macro should expand to a series of C
5177 file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
5178 named @code{__enable_execute_stack}. The target is responsible for
5179 emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
5180 @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT} hook.
5181 @end defmac
5182
5183 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5184 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5185 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5186 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5187 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5188
5189 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5190 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5191 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5192 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5193 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5194
5195 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5196 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5197 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5198 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5199 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5200 special assembler code.
5201 @end defmac
5202
5203 @node Library Calls
5204 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5205 @cindex library subroutine names
5206 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5207
5208 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5209 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5210
5211 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5212 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5213 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5214 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5215 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5216 @end defmac
5217
5218 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5219 @findex init_one_libfunc
5220 @hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5221 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5222 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5223 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5224 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5225 library routines.
5226
5227 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5228 @end deftypefn
5229
5230 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5231 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5232 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5233 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5234 return a tristate.
5235
5236 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5237 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5238 don't need to define this macro.
5239 @end defmac
5240
5241 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5242 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5243 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5244 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5245 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5246 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5247 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5248 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5249 @end defmac
5250
5251 @cindex US Software GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5252 @cindex floating point emulation library, US Software GOFAST
5253 @cindex GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5254 @findex gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs
5255 @defmac US_SOFTWARE_GOFAST
5256 Define this macro if your system C library uses the US Software GOFAST
5257 library to provide floating point emulation.
5258
5259 In addition to defining this macro, your architecture must set
5260 @code{TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS} to @code{gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs}, or
5261 else call that function from its version of that hook. It is defined
5262 in @file{config/gofast.h}, which must be included by your
5263 architecture's @file{@var{cpu}.c} file. See @file{sparc/sparc.c} for
5264 an example.
5265
5266 If this macro is defined, the
5267 @code{TARGET_FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL} target hook must return
5268 false for @code{SFmode} and @code{DFmode} comparisons.
5269 @end defmac
5270
5271 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5272 @findex matherr
5273 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5274 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5275 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5276 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5277 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5278 system.
5279
5280 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5281 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5282 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5283 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5284 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5285 @end defmac
5286
5287 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5288 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5289 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5290 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5291 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5292 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5293 @end defmac
5294
5295 @cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5296 @defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5297 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5298 @code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5299 default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5300 functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5301 systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5302 @end defmac
5303
5304 @cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5305 @defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5306 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5307 and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5308 default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5309 @smallexample
5310 void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5311 void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5312 void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5313 @end smallexample
5314 @end defmac
5315
5316 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5317 Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5318 the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5319 involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5320 at once to the method-lookup library function.
5321
5322 The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5323 to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5324 @end defmac
5325
5326 @node Addressing Modes
5327 @section Addressing Modes
5328 @cindex addressing modes
5329
5330 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5331 This is about addressing modes.
5332
5333 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5334 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5335 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5336 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5337 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5338 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5339 @end defmac
5340
5341 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5342 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5343 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5344 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5345 the size of the memory operand.
5346 @end defmac
5347
5348 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5349 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5350 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5351 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5352 @end defmac
5353
5354 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5355 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5356 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5357 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5358 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5359 constant addresses are supported.
5360 @end defmac
5361
5362 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5363 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5364 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5365 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5366 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5367 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5368 @end defmac
5369
5370 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5371 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5372 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5373 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5374 accept.
5375 @end defmac
5376
5377 @hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5378 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5379 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5380
5381 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5382 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5383 desired by the caller.
5384
5385 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5386 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5387 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5388 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5389 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5390 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5391 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5392 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5393
5394 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5395 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5396 register is required.
5397
5398 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5399 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5400 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5401 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5402 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5403
5404 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5405 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5406 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5407 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5408 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5409
5410 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5411 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5412 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5413 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5414 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5415 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5416 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5417 Format}.
5418
5419 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5420 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5421 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5422 has this syntax:
5423
5424 @example
5425 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5426 @end example
5427
5428 @noindent
5429 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5430 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5431
5432 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5433 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5434 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5435 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5436 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5437
5438 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5439 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5440 @end deftypefn
5441
5442 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5443 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5444 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5445 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5446 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5447 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5448 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5449 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5450 @code{'m'} constraint.
5451 @end defmac
5452
5453 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5454 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5455 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5456 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5457 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5458
5459 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5460 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5461
5462 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5463 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5464 @end defmac
5465
5466 @hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5467 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5468 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5469 address.
5470
5471 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5472 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5473 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5474 @var{x}.
5475
5476 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5477 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5478 should return the new @var{x}.
5479
5480 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5481 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5482 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5483 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5484 strategy can generate better code.
5485 @end deftypefn
5486
5487 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5488 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5489 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5490 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5491 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5492 performance reasons.
5493
5494 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5495 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5496 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5497 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5498 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5499 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5500 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5501 be shared.
5502
5503 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5504 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5505 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5506 of reload internals.
5507
5508 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5509 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5510 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5511
5512 @findex push_reload
5513 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5514 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5515 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5516
5517 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5518 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5519 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5520 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5521 @code{push_reload}.
5522
5523 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5524 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5525 the address has become legitimate.
5526
5527 @findex copy_rtx
5528 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5529 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5530 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5531 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5532 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5533 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5534 @end defmac
5535
5536 @hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5537 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5538 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5539 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5540 but not others.
5541
5542 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5543 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5544 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5545 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5546
5547 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5548
5549 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5550 @end deftypefn
5551
5552 @defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5553 A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5554 @var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5555 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5556 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5557 but not others.
5558
5559 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5560 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5561 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5562 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5563
5564 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5565
5566 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5567 @code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5568 @end defmac
5569
5570 @defmac LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5571 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5572 an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5573 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
5574 @samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
5575 anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
5576 @end defmac
5577
5578 @hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5579 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5580 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5581 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5582 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5583 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5584 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5585 into their original form.
5586 @end deftypefn
5587
5588 @hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5589 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5590 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. The default version of
5591 this hook returns false.
5592
5593 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5594 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5595 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5596 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5597 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5598 @end deftypefn
5599
5600 @hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5601 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5602 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5603 of @var{x}.
5604
5605 The default version returns false for all constants.
5606 @end deftypefn
5607
5608 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
5609 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5610 the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5611 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5612 when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5613 @var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5614 of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5615 function are valid.
5616 @end deftypefn
5617
5618 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5619 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5620 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5621 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5622 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5623
5624 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5625 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5626 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5627 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5628 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5629 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5630 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5631 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5632 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5633 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5634 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5635
5636 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5637 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5638 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5639 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5640 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5641 described above.
5642 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5643 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5644 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5645 @end deftypefn
5646
5647 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5648 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5649 widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5650
5651 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5652 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5653 widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5654 preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5655 @code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5656 @end deftypefn
5657
5658 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5659 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5660 widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5661
5662 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5663 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5664 widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5665 preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5666 @code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5667 @end deftypefn
5668
5669 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5670 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5671 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5672 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5673 @end deftypefn
5674
5675 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5676 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5677 @end deftypefn
5678
5679 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM
5680 Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5681 @end deftypefn
5682
5683 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK
5684 Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5685 @end deftypefn
5686
5687 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5688 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5689 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5690 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5691 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5692 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5693
5694 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5695 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5696 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5697 @end deftypefn
5698
5699 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5700 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5701 vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5702 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5703 The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5704 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5705 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5706 @end deftypefn
5707
5708 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5709 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5710 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5711 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5712 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5713 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5714 @end deftypefn
5715
5716 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5717 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5718 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5719 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5720 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5721 @end deftypefn
5722
5723 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5724 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5725 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5726 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5727 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5728 @end deftypefn
5729
5730 @node Anchored Addresses
5731 @section Anchored Addresses
5732 @cindex anchored addresses
5733 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5734
5735 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5736 For example, if we have:
5737
5738 @smallexample
5739 static int a, b, c;
5740 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5741 @end smallexample
5742
5743 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5744 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5745 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5746 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5747 be something like:
5748
5749 @smallexample
5750 int foo (void)
5751 @{
5752 register int *xr = &x;
5753 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5754 @}
5755 @end smallexample
5756
5757 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5758 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5759
5760 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5761 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5762 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5763 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5764
5765 @hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5766 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5767 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5768 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5769 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5770 @end deftypevr
5771
5772 @hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5773 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5774 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5775 value is 0.
5776 @end deftypevr
5777
5778 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5779 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5780 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5781 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5782 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5783
5784 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5785 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5786 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5787 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5788 @end deftypefn
5789
5790 @hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5791 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5792 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5793 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5794
5795 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5796 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5797 or target-specific sections.
5798 @end deftypefn
5799
5800 @node Condition Code
5801 @section Condition Code Status
5802 @cindex condition code status
5803
5804 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5805 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5806
5807 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5808 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5809 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5810 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5811 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5812 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5813 most RISC machines.
5814
5815 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5816 the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5817 insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5818 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5819 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5820 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5821 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5822 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5823
5824 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5825 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5826 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5827 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5828 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5829 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5830 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5831
5832 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5833 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5834 interested in most macros in this section.
5835
5836 @menu
5837 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5838 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5839 * Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5840 @end menu
5841
5842 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5843 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5844 @findex cc0
5845
5846 @findex cc_status
5847 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5848 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5849 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5850 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5851 currently based, and several standard flags.
5852
5853 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5854 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5855 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5856
5857 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5858 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5859 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5860
5861 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5862 @end defmac
5863
5864 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5865 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5866 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5867 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5868 define this macro to initialize it.
5869
5870 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5871 @end defmac
5872
5873 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5874 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5875 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5876 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5877 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5878 set @code{(cc0)}.
5879
5880 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5881
5882 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5883 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5884 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5885 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5886 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5887 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5888 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5889 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5890 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5891 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5892 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5893 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5894 condition code value.
5895
5896 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5897 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5898 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5899 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5900 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5901 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5902 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5903
5904 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5905 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5906 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5907 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5908 @end defmac
5909
5910 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5911 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5912 @findex CCmode
5913 @findex MODE_CC
5914
5915 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5916 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5917 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5918 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5919 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5920 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5921 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5922 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5923 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5924 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5925 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5926
5927 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5928 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5929 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5930 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5931 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5932 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5933 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5934
5935 @smallexample
5936 (define_insn ""
5937 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5938 (compare:CC_NOOV
5939 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5940 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5941 (const_int 0)))]
5942 ""
5943 "@dots{}")
5944 @end smallexample
5945
5946 @noindent
5947 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5948 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5949
5950 @smallexample
5951 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5952 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5953 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5954 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5955 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5956 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5957 @end smallexample
5958
5959 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5960 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5961 this section.
5962
5963 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5964 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5965 @end defmac
5966
5967 @defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5968 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5969 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5970 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5971 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5972
5973 On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5974 required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5975 and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5976 comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5977 @var{op1} as required.
5978
5979 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5980 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5981 @file{md} file.
5982
5983 You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5984 code or operands.
5985 @end defmac
5986
5987 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5988 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5989 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5990 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5991 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5992
5993 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5994 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5995 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5996 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5997
5998 @smallexample
5999 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6000 @end smallexample
6001 @end defmac
6002
6003 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6004 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6005 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6006 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6007 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6008 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6009 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6010 like:
6011
6012 @smallexample
6013 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6014 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6015 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6016 @end smallexample
6017 @end defmac
6018
6019 @hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
6020 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6021 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6022 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6023 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6024 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6025 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6026 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6027 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6028 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6029 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6030
6031 The default version of this hook returns false.
6032 @end deftypefn
6033
6034 @hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
6035 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6036 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6037 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6038 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6039 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6040 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6041
6042 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6043 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6044 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6045 @end deftypefn
6046
6047 @node Cond Exec Macros
6048 @subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6049 @findex conditional execution
6050 @findex predication
6051
6052 There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6053 supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6054 represent conditional branches.
6055
6056 @defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6057 A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6058 @var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6059 versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6060 predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6061 that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6062 If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6063
6064 @smallexample
6065 #define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6066 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6067 @end smallexample
6068 @end defmac
6069
6070 @node Costs
6071 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6072 @cindex costs of instructions
6073 @cindex relative costs
6074 @cindex speed of instructions
6075
6076 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6077 on the target machine.
6078
6079 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6080 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6081 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6082 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6083 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6084 that.
6085
6086 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6087 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6088 registers if they are not general registers.
6089
6090 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6091 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6092 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6093 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6094 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6095 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6096
6097 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6098 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6099 @end defmac
6100
6101 @hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6102 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6103 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6104 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6105 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6106 that.
6107
6108 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6109 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6110 registers if they are not general registers.
6111
6112 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6113 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6114 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6115 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6116 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6117 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6118
6119 The default version of this function returns 2.
6120 @end deftypefn
6121
6122 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6123 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6124 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6125 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6126 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6127 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6128 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6129
6130 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6131 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6132 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6133 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6134 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6135 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6136
6137 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6138 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6139 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6140 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6141 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6142 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6143 are the same as to this macro.
6144
6145 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6146 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6147 @end defmac
6148
6149 @hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
6150 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6151 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6152 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6153 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6154 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6155 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6156
6157 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6158 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6159 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6160 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6161 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6162 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6163
6164 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6165 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6166 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6167 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6168 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6169 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6170 are the same as to this target hook.
6171 @end deftypefn
6172
6173 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6174 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is the
6175 default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter @var{speed_p}
6176 is true when the branch in question should be optimized for speed. When
6177 it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should be returning value optimal for code size
6178 rather then performance considerations. @var{predictable_p} is true for well
6179 predictable branches. On many architectures the @code{BRANCH_COST} can be
6180 reduced then.
6181 @end defmac
6182
6183 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6184 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6185 ordinarily expect.
6186
6187 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6188 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6189 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6190 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6191 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6192 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6193
6194 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6195 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6196 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6197 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6198 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6199 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6200 @end defmac
6201
6202 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6203 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6204 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6205 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6206 handler.
6207
6208 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6209 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6210 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6211 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6212 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6213
6214 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6215 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6216 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6217 @end defmac
6218
6219 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6220 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6221 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6222 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6223 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6224
6225 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6226 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6227 the number of such sequences.
6228
6229 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6230 optimized for speed rather than size.
6231
6232 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6233 @end defmac
6234
6235 @defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6236 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6237 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6238 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6239 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6240 @end defmac
6241
6242 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6243 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6244 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6245 @end defmac
6246
6247 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6248 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6249 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6250 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6251 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6252
6253 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6254 optimized for speed rather than size.
6255
6256 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6257 @end defmac
6258
6259 @defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6260 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6261 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6262 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6263 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6264 @end defmac
6265
6266 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6267 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6268 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6269 a block set insn or a library call.
6270 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6271 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6272
6273 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6274 optimized for speed rather than size.
6275
6276 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6277 @end defmac
6278
6279 @defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6280 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6281 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6282 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6283 storing values other than constant zero.
6284 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6285 than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6286 @end defmac
6287
6288 @defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6289 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6290 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6291 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6292 called with a constant source string.
6293 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6294 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6295 @end defmac
6296
6297 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6298 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6299 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6300 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6301 @end defmac
6302
6303 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6304 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6305 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6306 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6307 @end defmac
6308
6309 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6310 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6311 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6312 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6313 @end defmac
6314
6315 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6316 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6317 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6318 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6319 @end defmac
6320
6321 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6322 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6323 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6324 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6325 @end defmac
6326
6327 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6328 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6329 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6330 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6331 @end defmac
6332
6333 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6334 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6335 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6336 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6337 @end defmac
6338
6339 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6340 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6341 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6342 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6343 @end defmac
6344
6345 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6346 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6347 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6348 @end defmac
6349
6350 @defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6351 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6352 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6353 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6354 @end defmac
6355
6356 @hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6357 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6358
6359 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6360 available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6361 in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6362 expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6363 @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6364
6365 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6366 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6367 instructions.
6368
6369 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6370 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6371 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6372 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6373 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6374
6375 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6376 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6377 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6378
6379 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6380 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6381 @end deftypefn
6382
6383 @hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6384 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6385 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6386 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6387
6388 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6389 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6390 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6391 all addresses will have equal costs.
6392
6393 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6394 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6395 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6396
6397 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6398 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6399 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6400 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6401 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6402 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6403 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6404 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6405
6406 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6407
6408 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6409 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6410 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6411 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6412 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6413 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6414 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6415 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6416 @end deftypefn
6417
6418 @node Scheduling
6419 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6420
6421 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6422 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6423 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6424 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6425
6426 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6427 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6428 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6429 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6430 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6431 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6432 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6433 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6434 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6435 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6436 @end deftypefn
6437
6438 @hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6439 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6440 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6441 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6442 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6443 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6444 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6445 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6446 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6447 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6448 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6449 was scheduled.
6450 @end deftypefn
6451
6452 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6453 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6454 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6455 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6456 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6457 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6458 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6459 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6460 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6461 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6462 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6463 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6464 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6465 @end deftypefn
6466
6467 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6468 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6469 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6470 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6471 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6472 scheduling priorities of insns.
6473 @end deftypefn
6474
6475 @hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6476 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6477 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6478 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6479 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6480 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6481 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6482 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6483 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6484 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6485 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6486 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6487 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6488 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6489 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6490 @end deftypefn
6491
6492 @hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6493 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6494 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6495 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6496 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6497 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6498 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6499 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6500 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6501 @end deftypefn
6502
6503 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6504 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6505 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6506 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6507 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6508 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6509 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6510 calculated.
6511 @end deftypefn
6512
6513 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6514 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6515 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6516 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6517 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6518 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6519 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6520 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6521 @end deftypefn
6522
6523 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6524 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6525 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6526 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6527 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6528 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6529 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6530 @end deftypefn
6531
6532 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6533 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6534 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6535 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6536 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6537 @end deftypefn
6538
6539 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6540 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6541 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6542 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6543 @end deftypefn
6544
6545 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6546 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6547 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6548 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6549 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6550 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6551 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6552 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6553 @end deftypefn
6554
6555 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6556 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6557 @end deftypefn
6558
6559 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6560 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6561 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6562 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6563 @end deftypefn
6564
6565 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6566 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6567 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6568 @end deftypefn
6569
6570 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6571 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6572 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6573 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6574 state on a single insn is not enough.
6575 @end deftypefn
6576
6577 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6578 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6579 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6580 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6581 state on a single insn is not enough.
6582 @end deftypefn
6583
6584 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6585 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6586 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6587 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6588 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6589 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6590 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6591 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6592 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6593 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6594 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6595
6596 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6597 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6598 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6599 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6600 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6601 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6602 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6603 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6604 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6605
6606 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6607 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6608 schedules to choose the best one.
6609
6610 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6611 @end deftypefn
6612
6613 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6614
6615 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6616 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6617 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6618 be issued.
6619
6620 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6621 @end deftypefn
6622
6623 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN
6624 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6625 scheduling.
6626 @end deftypefn
6627
6628 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE
6629 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6630 @end deftypefn
6631
6632 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK
6633 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6634 an instruction.
6635 @end deftypefn
6636
6637 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END
6638 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6639 round of multipass scheduling.
6640 @end deftypefn
6641
6642 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT
6643 This hook initilizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6644 @end deftypefn
6645
6646 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI
6647 This hook finilizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6648 @end deftypefn
6649
6650 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
6651 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6652 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6653 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6654 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6655 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6656 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6657 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6658 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6659 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6660 and the current processor cycle.
6661 @end deftypefn
6662
6663 @hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6664 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6665 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6666 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6667 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6668 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6669 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6670 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6671 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6672 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6673 and @code{false} otherwise.
6674
6675 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6676 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6677 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6678 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6679 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6680 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6681 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6682 @end deftypefn
6683
6684 @hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6685 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6686 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6687 per instruction data structures.
6688 @end deftypefn
6689
6690 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6691 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6692 @end deftypefn
6693
6694 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6695 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6696 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6697 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6698 @end deftypefn
6699
6700 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6701 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6702 @end deftypefn
6703
6704 @hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6705 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6706 @end deftypefn
6707
6708 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6709 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6710 @end deftypefn
6711
6712 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6713 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6714 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6715 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6716 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6717 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6718 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6719 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6720 the generated speculative pattern.
6721 @end deftypefn
6722
6723 @hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6724 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6725 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6726 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6727 @end deftypefn
6728
6729 @hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6730 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6731 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6732 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6733 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6734 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6735 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6736 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6737 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6738 @end deftypefn
6739
6740 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6741 This hook is used as a workaround for
6742 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6743 called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6744 discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6745 being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6746 @var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6747 For non-speculative instructions,
6748 the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6749 the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6750 is nearly full.
6751 @end deftypefn
6752
6753 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6754 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6755 enabled/used.
6756 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6757 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6758 @end deftypefn
6759
6760 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6761 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6762 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6763 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6764 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6765 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6766 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6767 @end deftypefn
6768
6769 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6770 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6771 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6772 @end deftypefn
6773
6774 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6775 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6776 in its second parameter.
6777 @end deftypefn
6778
6779 @node Sections
6780 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6781 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6782 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6783
6784 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6785 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6786 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6787 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6788 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6789 of sections.
6790
6791 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6792 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6793 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6794 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6795 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6796 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6797 They may however depend on command-line flags.
6798
6799 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6800 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6801 to be string literals.
6802
6803 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6804 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6805 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6806 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6807
6808 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6809 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6810 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6811 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6812 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6813 reuse @code{text_section}.
6814
6815 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6816 if the target does not provide them.
6817
6818 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6819 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6820 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6821 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6822 @end defmac
6823
6824 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6825 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6826 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6827 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6828 @end defmac
6829
6830 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6831 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6832 executed functions in the program.
6833 @end defmac
6834
6835 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6836 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6837 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6838 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6839 @end defmac
6840
6841 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6842 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6843 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6844 initialized, writable small data.
6845 @end defmac
6846
6847 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6848 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6849 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6850 data.
6851 @end defmac
6852
6853 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6854 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6855 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6856 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
6857 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
6858 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6859 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6860 used.
6861 @end defmac
6862
6863 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6864 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6865 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6866 uninitialized, writable small data.
6867 @end defmac
6868
6869 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6870 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6871 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6872 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6873 @end defmac
6874
6875 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6876 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6877 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6878 default is @code{'T'}.
6879 @end defmac
6880
6881 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6882 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6883 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6884 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6885 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6886 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6887 @end defmac
6888
6889 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6890 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6891 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6892 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6893 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6894 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6895 @end defmac
6896
6897 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6898 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6899 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6900 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6901 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6902 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6903 @end defmac
6904
6905 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6906 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6907 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6908 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6909 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6910 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6911 @end defmac
6912
6913 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6914 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6915 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6916 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6917 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6918 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6919 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6920 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6921 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6922 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6923 @end defmac
6924
6925 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6926 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6927 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6928 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6929 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6930 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6931 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6932 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6933 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6934 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6935 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6936 @end defmac
6937
6938 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6939 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6940 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6941 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6942 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6943 @end defmac
6944
6945 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6946 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6947 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6948 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6949 readonly data section is used.
6950
6951 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6952 @end defmac
6953
6954 @hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6955 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6956 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6957 of its own that you need to create.
6958
6959 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6960 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6961 described below.
6962 @end deftypefn
6963
6964 @hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6965 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6966 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6967 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6968 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6969
6970 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6971 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6972 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6973 in read-only sections even in executables.
6974 @end deftypefn
6975
6976 @hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6977 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6978 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6979 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6980 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6981 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6982 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6983
6984 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6985 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6986
6987 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6988 @end deftypefn
6989
6990 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6991 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6992 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6993
6994 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6995 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6996 it is unlikely to be called.
6997 @end defmac
6998
6999 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
7000 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7001 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7002 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7003 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7004
7005 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7006 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7007 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7008 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7009 @end deftypefn
7010
7011 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
7012 Return the readonly data section associated with
7013 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7014 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7015 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7016 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7017 otherwise.
7018 @end deftypefn
7019
7020 @hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
7021 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7022 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7023 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7024 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7025 in bits.
7026
7027 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7028 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7029 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7030 @end deftypefn
7031
7032 @hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7033 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7034 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7035 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7036 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7037 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7038 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7039 returns the @var{id} provided.
7040 @end deftypefn
7041
7042 @hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7043 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7044 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7045 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7046
7047 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7048 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7049 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7050 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7051 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7052
7053 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7054 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7055 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7056 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7057 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7058 leave it alone.)
7059
7060 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7061 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7062 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7063 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7064 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7065 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7066
7067 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7068 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7069 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7070 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7071 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7072 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7073
7074 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7075 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7076 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7077 before overriding it.
7078 @end deftypefn
7079
7080 @hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7081 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7082 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7083 may have added.
7084 @end deftypefn
7085
7086 @hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7087 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7088 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7089 @end deftypefn
7090
7091 @hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7092 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7093 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7094 @end deftypevr
7095
7096 @hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7097
7098 @hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7099 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7100 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7101 or executable image).
7102
7103 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7104 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7105 currently supported object file formats.
7106 @end deftypefn
7107
7108 @hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7109 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7110 The default value is false.
7111 @end deftypevr
7112
7113
7114 @node PIC
7115 @section Position Independent Code
7116 @cindex position independent code
7117 @cindex PIC
7118
7119 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7120 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7121 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7122 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7123 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7124 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7125 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7126 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7127 relative addresses.
7128 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7129 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7130
7131 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7132 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7133 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7134 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7135 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7136 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7137 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7138 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7139 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7140 @end defmac
7141
7142 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7143 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7144 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7145 the default is zero. Do not define
7146 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7147 @end defmac
7148
7149 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7150 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7151 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7152 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7153 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7154 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7155 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7156 position independent code.
7157 @end defmac
7158
7159 @node Assembler Format
7160 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7161
7162 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7163 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7164 instructions do.
7165
7166 @menu
7167 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7168 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7169 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7170 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7171 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7172 and termination routines.
7173 * Macros for Initialization::
7174 Specific macros that control the handling of
7175 initialization and termination routines.
7176 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7177 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7178 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7179 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7180 @end menu
7181
7182 @node File Framework
7183 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7184 @cindex assembler format
7185 @cindex output of assembler code
7186
7187 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7188 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7189
7190 @findex default_file_start
7191 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7192 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7193 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7194 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7195 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7196 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7197 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7198 @end deftypefn
7199
7200 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7201 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7202 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7203 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7204 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7205 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7206 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7207 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7208
7209 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7210 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7211 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7212 @end deftypevr
7213
7214 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7215 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7216 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7217 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7218 this to be done. The default is false.
7219 @end deftypevr
7220
7221 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7222 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7223 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7224 @end deftypefn
7225
7226 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7227 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7228 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7229 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7230 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7231 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7232 this function.
7233 @end deftypefun
7234
7235 @hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7236 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7237 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7238 nothing.
7239 @end deftypefn
7240
7241 @hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7242 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7243 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7244 nothing.
7245 @end deftypefn
7246
7247 @hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7248 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7249 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7250 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7251 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7252 nothing.
7253 @end deftypefn
7254
7255 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7256 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7257 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7258 the end of the line.
7259 @end defmac
7260
7261 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7262 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7263 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7264 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7265 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7266 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7267 @end defmac
7268
7269 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7270 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7271 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7272 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7273 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7274 @end defmac
7275
7276 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7277 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7278 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7279 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7280
7281 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7282 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7283 @end defmac
7284
7285 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7286
7287 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7288 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7289 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7290 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7291 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7292 of the filename using this macro.
7293 @end defmac
7294
7295 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7296 A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7297 @samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7298 macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7299 @end defmac
7300
7301 @hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7302 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7303 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7304 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7305 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7306 this section is associated.
7307 @end deftypefn
7308
7309 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION
7310 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7311 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7312 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7313 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7314 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7315 (from static destructors).
7316 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7317 @end deftypefn
7318
7319 @hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7320 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7321 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7322 @end deftypevr
7323
7324 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7325 @hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7326 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7327 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7328 This is true on most ELF targets.
7329 @end deftypevr
7330
7331 @hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7332 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7333 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7334 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7335 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7336
7337 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7338 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7339 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7340 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7341 @end deftypefn
7342
7343 @hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7344 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7345 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7346 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7347 It can take the following values:
7348
7349 @table @gcctabopt
7350 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7351 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7352
7353 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7354 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7355 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7356 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7357 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7358 various different individual optimization passes.
7359
7360 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7361 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7362 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7363 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7364 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7365 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7366 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7367 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7368 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7369 switches.
7370
7371 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7372 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7373
7374 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7375 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7376 @end table
7377
7378 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7379 supported in the future.
7380
7381 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7382 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7383 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7384 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7385 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7386 hook.
7387 @end deftypefn
7388
7389 @hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7390 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7391 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7392 hook.
7393 @end deftypevr
7394
7395 @need 2000
7396 @node Data Output
7397 @subsection Output of Data
7398
7399
7400 @hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7401 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7402 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7403 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7404 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7405 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7406 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7407 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7408 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7409 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7410 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7411 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7412 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7413 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7414
7415 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7416 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7417 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7418 @end deftypevr
7419
7420 @hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7421 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7422 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7423 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7424 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7425 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7426 split the object into smaller parts.
7427
7428 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7429 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7430 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7431 @end deftypefn
7432
7433 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7434 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7435 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7436 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7437 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7438
7439 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7440 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7441 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7442 return @code{true}.
7443 @end deftypefn
7444
7445 @defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7446 A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7447 @code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7448 @var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7449 allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7450
7451 If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7452 @code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7453 prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7454 @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7455 @end defmac
7456
7457 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7458 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7459 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7460 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7461 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7462
7463 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7464 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7465 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7466 @end defmac
7467
7468 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7469 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7470 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7471 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7472 @end defmac
7473
7474 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7475 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7476 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7477 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7478 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7479 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7480 pool before the function.
7481 @end defmac
7482
7483 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7484 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7485 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7486 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7487 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7488 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7489 immediately after this call.
7490
7491 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7492 not be defined.
7493 @end defmac
7494
7495 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7496 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7497 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7498 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7499
7500 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7501 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7502 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7503 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7504 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7505 alignment.
7506
7507 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7508 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7509 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7510 Here is how to do this:
7511
7512 @smallexample
7513 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7514 @end smallexample
7515
7516 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7517 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7518 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7519
7520 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7521 @end defmac
7522
7523 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7524 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7525 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7526 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7527 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7528 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7529
7530 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7531 define this macro.
7532 @end defmac
7533
7534 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7535 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7536 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7537 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7538 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7539
7540 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7541 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7542 @end defmac
7543
7544 @hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7545 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7546 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7547 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7548 @end deftypevr
7549
7550 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7551 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7552
7553 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7554 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7555 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7556 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7557 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7558 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7559 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7560 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7561 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7562 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7563 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7564 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7565 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7566 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7567 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7568 on the host machine.
7569
7570 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7571 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7572 machine's memory.
7573 @end defmac
7574
7575 @node Uninitialized Data
7576 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7577
7578 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7579 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7580
7581 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7582 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7583 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7584 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7585 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7586 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7587 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7588 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7589 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7590 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7591 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7592 an ordinary undefined external.
7593
7594 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7595 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7596 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7597
7598 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7599 common global variables are output.
7600 @end defmac
7601
7602 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7603 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7604 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7605 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7606 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7607 as the number of bits.
7608 @end defmac
7609
7610 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7611 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7612 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7613 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7614 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7615 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7616 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7617 @end defmac
7618
7619 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7620 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7621 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7622 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7623 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7624
7625 Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
7626 defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7627 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7628 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7629 the name, and a newline.
7630
7631 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define either
7632 this macro or its aligned counterpart, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS}.
7633 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7634 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7635 You do not need to do both.
7636
7637 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7638 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7639 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7640 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7641 common in order to save space in the object file.
7642 @end defmac
7643
7644 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7645 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
7646 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7647 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
7648 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7649 as the number of bits.
7650
7651 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7652 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
7653 @end defmac
7654
7655 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7656 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7657 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7658 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7659 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7660
7661 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7662 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7663 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7664
7665 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7666 static variables are output.
7667 @end defmac
7668
7669 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7670 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7671 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7672 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7673 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7674 as the number of bits.
7675 @end defmac
7676
7677 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7678 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7679 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7680 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7681 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7682 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7683 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7684 @end defmac
7685
7686 @node Label Output
7687 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7688
7689 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7690 This is about outputting labels.
7691
7692 @findex assemble_name
7693 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7694 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7695 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7696 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7697 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7698 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7699 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7700 @end defmac
7701
7702 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7703 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7704 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7705 a function.
7706 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7707 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7708 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7709 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7710
7711 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7712 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7713 @end defmac
7714
7715 @findex assemble_name_raw
7716 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7717 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7718 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7719 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7720 that it is more efficient.
7721 @end defmac
7722
7723 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7724 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7725 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7726 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7727 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7728
7729 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7730 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7731 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7732 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7733 define this macro.
7734 @end defmac
7735
7736 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7737 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7738 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7739 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7740 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7741 provided.
7742 @end defmac
7743
7744 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7745 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7746 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7747 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7748 address.
7749
7750 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7751 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7752 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7753 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7754 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7755 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7756 @end defmac
7757
7758 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7759 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7760 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7761 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7762 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7763
7764 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7765 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7766 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7767 types at all, do not define this macro.
7768 @end defmac
7769
7770 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7771 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7772 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7773 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7774 the default is not to define this macro.
7775
7776 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7777 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7778 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7779 types at all, do not define this macro.
7780 @end defmac
7781
7782 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7783 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7784 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7785 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7786 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7787 you should not count on this.
7788
7789 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7790 definition of this macro is provided.
7791 @end defmac
7792
7793 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7794 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7795 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7796 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7797 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7798 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7799 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7800
7801 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7802 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7803
7804 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7805 of this macro.
7806 @end defmac
7807
7808 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7809 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7810 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7811 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7812 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7813 representing the function.
7814
7815 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7816
7817 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7818 of this macro.
7819 @end defmac
7820
7821 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7822 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7823 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7824 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7825 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7826 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7827
7828 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7829 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7830
7831 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7832 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7833 @end defmac
7834
7835 @hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
7836 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7837 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7838 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7839 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7840 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7841 will be an internal label.
7842
7843 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7844 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7845
7846 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7847 @end deftypefn
7848
7849 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7850 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7851 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7852 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7853
7854 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7855 nothing.
7856 @end defmac
7857
7858 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7859 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7860 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7861 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7862 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7863 something about the size of the object.
7864
7865 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7866 nothing.
7867
7868 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7869 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7870 @end defmac
7871
7872 @hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7873 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7874 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7875 that is, available for reference from other files.
7876
7877 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7878 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7879 @end deftypefn
7880
7881 @hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7882 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7883 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7884 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7885
7886 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7887 @end deftypefn
7888
7889 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7890 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7891 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7892 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7893 no other definition is available. Use the expression
7894 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7895 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7896 for making that name weak, and a newline.
7897
7898 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7899 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7900 macro.
7901 @end defmac
7902
7903 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7904 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7905 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7906 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7907 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7908 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7909 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7910 to make @var{name} weak.
7911 @end defmac
7912
7913 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7914 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7915 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7916 declaration of @code{name}.
7917 @end defmac
7918
7919 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
7920 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7921 supports weak symbols.
7922
7923 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7924 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
7925 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7926 @end defmac
7927
7928 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7929 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7930
7931 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7932 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7933 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7934 flag such as @option{-melf}.
7935 @end defmac
7936
7937 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7938 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7939 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7940 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7941 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7942 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7943 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7944 @end defmac
7945
7946 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7947 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7948 semantics.
7949
7950 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7951 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7952 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7953 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7954 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7955 be emitted as one-only.
7956 @end defmac
7957
7958 @hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7959 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7960 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7961 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7962 @end deftypefn
7963
7964 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7965 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7966 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7967 The default is @code{0}.
7968
7969 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7970 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7971 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7972 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7973 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7974 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7975 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7976
7977 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7978 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7979 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7980 table of contents.
7981 @end defmac
7982
7983 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7984 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7985 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7986 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7987 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7988 declaration.
7989
7990 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7991 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7992 @end defmac
7993
7994 @hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
7995 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7996 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
7997 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7998 @end deftypefn
7999
8000 @hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
8001 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8002 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8003 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8004 @end deftypefn
8005
8006 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8007 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8008 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8009 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8010 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8011 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8012 @end defmac
8013
8014 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8015 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8016 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8017 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8018 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8019 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8020 @end defmac
8021
8022 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8023 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8024 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8025 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8026 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8027 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8028 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8029 being taken.
8030 @end defmac
8031
8032 @hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
8033 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8034 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8035
8036 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8037 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8038 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8039
8040 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8041 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8042 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8043 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8044 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8045
8046 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8047 @end deftypefn
8048
8049 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8050 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8051 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8052 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8053 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8054 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8055 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8056 bundles.
8057
8058 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8059 used.
8060 @end defmac
8061
8062 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8063 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8064 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8065
8066 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8067 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8068 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8069
8070 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8071 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8072 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8073 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8074 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8075 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8076 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8077 @end defmac
8078
8079 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8080 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8081 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8082 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8083 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8084
8085 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8086 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8087 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8088 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8089 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8090 internal static variables in different scopes.
8091
8092 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8093 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8094 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8095 between the name and the number will suffice.
8096
8097 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8098 which is correct for most systems.
8099 @end defmac
8100
8101 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8102 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8103 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8104
8105 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8106 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8107 correct for most systems.
8108 @end defmac
8109
8110 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8111 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8112 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8113 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8114 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8115 the tree nodes are available.
8116
8117 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8118 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8119 correct for most systems.
8120 @end defmac
8121
8122 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8123 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8124 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8125 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8126 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8127 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8128 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8129 @end defmac
8130
8131 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8132 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8133 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8134 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8135 an undefined weak symbol.
8136
8137 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8138 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8139 @end defmac
8140
8141 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8142 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8143 Objective-C methods.
8144
8145 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8146 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8147 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8148 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8149
8150 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8151 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8152 systems define other ways of computing names.
8153
8154 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8155 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8156 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8157 50 characters extra.
8158
8159 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8160 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8161 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8162 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8163
8164 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8165 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8166 @end defmac
8167
8168 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8169 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8170 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8171 Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8172 linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8173 @end defmac
8174
8175 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8176 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8177 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8178 unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8179 whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8180 @end defmac
8181
8182 @node Initialization
8183 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8184 @cindex initialization routines
8185 @cindex termination routines
8186 @cindex constructors, output of
8187 @cindex destructors, output of
8188
8189 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8190 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8191 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8192 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8193 @code{main} is called.
8194
8195 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8196 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8197 terminates.
8198
8199 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8200 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8201 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8202 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8203
8204 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8205 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8206 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8207
8208 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8209 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8210 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8211 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8212 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8213
8214 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8215 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8216 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8217 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8218 pointer containing zero.
8219
8220 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8221 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8222 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8223 list; destructors in forward order.
8224
8225 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8226 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8227 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8228 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8229 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8230 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8231 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8232 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8233
8234 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8235 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8236 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8237 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8238 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8239
8240 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8241 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8242 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8243 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8244 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8245
8246 @smallexample
8247 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8248 @end smallexample
8249
8250 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8251 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8252 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8253 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8254 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8255
8256 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8257 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8258 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8259 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8260 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8261 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8262
8263 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8264 macro properly.
8265
8266 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8267 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8268 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8269 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8270 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8271 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8272
8273 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8274 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8275 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8276 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8277 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8278 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8279 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8280 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8281 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8282 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8283 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8284 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8285 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8286 the initialization process.
8287
8288 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8289 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8290 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8291 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8292 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8293 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8294 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8295 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8296 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8297 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8298 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8299
8300 @ifinfo
8301 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8302 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8303 @end ifinfo
8304
8305 @node Macros for Initialization
8306 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8307
8308 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8309 and termination functions:
8310
8311 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8312 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8313 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8314 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8315 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8316 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8317 run the initialization functions.
8318 @end defmac
8319
8320 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8321 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8322 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8323 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8324 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8325 @end defmac
8326
8327 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8328 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8329 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8330 @end defmac
8331
8332 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8333 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8334 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8335 @end defmac
8336
8337 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8338 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8339 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8340 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8341 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8342 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8343
8344 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8345 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8346 exception tables embedded in the code.
8347 @end defmac
8348
8349 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8350 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8351 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8352 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8353 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8354 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8355 @end defmac
8356
8357 @defmac INVOKE__main
8358 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8359 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8360 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8361 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8362 @end defmac
8363
8364 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8365 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8366 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8367 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8368 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8369 @end defmac
8370
8371 @hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8372 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8373 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8374 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8375 @end deftypevr
8376
8377 @hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8378 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8379 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8380
8381 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8382 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8383 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8384 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8385
8386 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8387 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8388 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8389 is not defined.
8390 @end deftypefn
8391
8392 @hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8393 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8394 functions rather than initialization functions.
8395 @end deftypefn
8396
8397 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8398 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8399
8400 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8401 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8402 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8403
8404 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8405 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8406
8407 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8408 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8409 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8410 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8411
8412 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8413 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8414 @end defmac
8415
8416 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8417 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8418 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8419 @command{nm}.
8420 @end defmac
8421
8422 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8423 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8424 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8425 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8426 are needed to get the same output formut as GNU @command{nm -n}
8427 produces.
8428 @end defmac
8429
8430 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8431 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8432 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8433 termination functions in shared libraries:
8434
8435 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8436 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8437 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8438 @end defmac
8439
8440 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8441 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8442 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8443 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8444 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8445 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8446 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8447 @end defmac
8448
8449 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8450 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8451 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8452 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8453 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8454 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8455 @end defmac
8456
8457 @node Instruction Output
8458 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8459
8460 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8461 This describes assembler instruction output.
8462
8463 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8464 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8465 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8466 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8467 @end defmac
8468
8469 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8470 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8471 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8472 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8473 to registers using alternate names.
8474 @end defmac
8475
8476 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8477 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8478 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8479 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8480 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8481 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8482 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8483 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8484
8485 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8486 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8487 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8488 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8489 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8490 @end defmac
8491
8492 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8493 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8494 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8495
8496 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8497 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8498 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8499 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8500 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8501 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8502 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8503 so that it will not be output twice.
8504
8505 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8506 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8507 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8508 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8509 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8510
8511 @findex recog_data.operand
8512 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8513 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8514
8515 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8516 in the usual way.
8517 @end defmac
8518
8519 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8520 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8521 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8522 they will be output differently.
8523
8524 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8525 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8526 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8527 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8528 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8529 by changing the contents of the vector.
8530
8531 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8532 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8533 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8534 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8535 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8536 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8537
8538 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8539 @end defmac
8540
8541 @hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8542 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8543 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8544 if necessary.
8545
8546 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8547 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8548 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8549 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8550 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8551 by checking the contents of the vector.
8552 @end deftypefn
8553
8554 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8555 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8556 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8557 RTL expression.
8558
8559 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8560 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8561 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8562 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8563 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8564 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8565 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8566
8567 @findex reg_names
8568 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8569 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8570 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8571 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8572
8573 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8574 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8575 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8576 @var{code}.
8577 @end defmac
8578
8579 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8580 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8581 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8582 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8583 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8584 in this way.
8585 @end defmac
8586
8587 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8588 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8589 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8590 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8591
8592 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8593 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8594 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8595 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8596 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8597 Format}.
8598 @end defmac
8599
8600 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8601 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8602 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8603 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8604 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8605 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8606 or whatever.
8607
8608 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8609 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8610 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8611 @end defmac
8612
8613 @findex final_sequence
8614 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8615 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8616 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8617 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8618 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8619 being output.
8620
8621 @findex asm_fprintf
8622 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8623 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8624 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8625 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8626 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8627 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8628 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8629 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8630 files can define these macros differently.
8631 @end defmac
8632
8633 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8634 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8635 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8636 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8637 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8638 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8639 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8640 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8641 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8642 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8643 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8644 @end defmac
8645
8646 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8647 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8648 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8649 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8650 first variant.
8651
8652 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8653 @smallexample
8654 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8655 @end smallexample
8656 @noindent
8657 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8658 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8659 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8660 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8661 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8662 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8663 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8664
8665 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8666 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8667 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8668
8669 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8670 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8671 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8672 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8673 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8674 opcodes or operand order.
8675 @end defmac
8676
8677 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8678 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8679 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8680 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8681 profiling.
8682 @end defmac
8683
8684 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8685 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8686 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8687 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8688 profiling.
8689 @end defmac
8690
8691 @node Dispatch Tables
8692 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8693
8694 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8695 This concerns dispatch tables.
8696
8697 @cindex dispatch table
8698 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8699 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8700 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8701 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8702 definitions of these labels are output using
8703 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8704 way here. For example,
8705
8706 @smallexample
8707 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8708 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8709 @end smallexample
8710
8711 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8712 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8713 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8714 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8715 mode and flags can be read.
8716 @end defmac
8717
8718 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8719 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8720 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8721
8722 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8723 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8724 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8725 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8726 For example,
8727
8728 @smallexample
8729 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8730 @end smallexample
8731 @end defmac
8732
8733 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8734 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8735 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8736 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8737 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8738 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8739
8740 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8741 for the table.
8742
8743 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8744 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8745 @end defmac
8746
8747 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8748 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8749 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8750 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8751 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8752 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8753 of the preceding label.
8754
8755 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8756 the jump-table.
8757 @end defmac
8758
8759 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8760 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8761 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8762 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8763 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8764 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8765 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8766 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8767
8768 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8769 @end deftypefn
8770
8771 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8772 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8773 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8774 to be broken up according to function.
8775
8776 The default is that no label is emitted.
8777 @end deftypefn
8778
8779 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8780
8781 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8782 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8783 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8784 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8785 @end deftypefn
8786
8787 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8788
8789 @node Exception Region Output
8790 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8791
8792 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8793
8794 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8795 region.
8796
8797 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8798 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8799 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8800 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8801 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8802
8803 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8804 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8805 @end defmac
8806
8807 @defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8808 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8809 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8810 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8811 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8812
8813 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8814 also defined.
8815 @end defmac
8816
8817 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8818 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8819 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8820 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8821 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8822 @end defmac
8823
8824 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8825 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8826 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8827 @end defmac
8828
8829 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8830 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8831 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8832 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8833 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8834 or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8835 @end defmac
8836
8837 @hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8838 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8839 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8840 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8841 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8842 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8843 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8844
8845 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8846 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8847 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8848
8849 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8850 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8851 @var{opts}. In particular, the
8852 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8853 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8854 depending on this setting.
8855
8856 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8857 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8858 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8859 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8860 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
8861 @end deftypefn
8862
8863 @hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8864 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8865 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8866 command-line option processing.
8867 @end deftypevr
8868
8869 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8870 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8871 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8872 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8873 @end defmac
8874
8875 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8876 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8877 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8878 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8879 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8880 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8881 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8882 @end defmac
8883
8884 @hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8885 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8886 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8887 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8888 true otherwise.
8889 @end deftypevr
8890
8891 @hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8892 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8893 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8894 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8895 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8896 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8897 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8898 @end deftypefn
8899
8900 @hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8901 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8902 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8903 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8904 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8905 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8906 @var{address} is the address of the table.
8907 @end deftypefn
8908
8909 @hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8910 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8911 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8912 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8913 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8914 @end deftypefn
8915
8916 @hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8917 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8918 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8919 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8920 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8921 @end deftypevr
8922
8923 @node Alignment Output
8924 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8925
8926 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8927 This describes commands for alignment.
8928
8929 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8930 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8931 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8932
8933 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8934 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8935 define the macro.
8936
8937 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8938 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8939 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8940 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8941 @end defmac
8942
8943 @hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8944 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8945 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8946 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8947 @end deftypefn
8948
8949 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8950 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8951 a @code{BARRIER}.
8952
8953 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8954 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8955 define the macro.
8956 @end defmac
8957
8958 @hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8959 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8960 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8961 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8962 @end deftypefn
8963
8964 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8965 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8966 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8967
8968 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8969 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8970 define the macro.
8971
8972 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8973 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8974 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8975 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8976 @end defmac
8977
8978 @hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8979 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8980 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8981 defined.
8982 @end deftypefn
8983
8984 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8985 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8986 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8987 the maximum of the specified values is used.
8988
8989 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8990 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8991 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8992 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8993 @end defmac
8994
8995 @hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8996 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8997 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8998 is defined.
8999 @end deftypefn
9000
9001 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9002 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9003 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9004 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9005 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9006 @end defmac
9007
9008 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9009 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9010 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9011 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9012 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9013 section.
9014 @end defmac
9015
9016 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9017 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9018 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9019 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9020 @end defmac
9021
9022 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9023 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9024 for padding, if necessary.
9025 @end defmac
9026
9027 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9028 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9029 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9030 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9031 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9032 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9033 @end defmac
9034
9035 @need 3000
9036 @node Debugging Info
9037 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9038
9039 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9040 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9041
9042 @menu
9043 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9044 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9045 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9046 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9047 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9048 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9049 @end menu
9050
9051 @node All Debuggers
9052 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9053
9054 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9055 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9056
9057 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9058 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9059 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9060 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9061 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9062 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9063 compiler and another for DBX@.
9064
9065 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9066 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9067 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9068 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9069 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9070
9071 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9072 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9073 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9074 @end defmac
9075
9076 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9077 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9078 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9079 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9080 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9081 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9082 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9083 @option{-g} options is used.
9084 @end defmac
9085
9086 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9087 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9088 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9089 @var{offset}.
9090 @end defmac
9091
9092 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9093 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9094 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9095 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9096 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9097 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9098 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9099
9100 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9101 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9102 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9103 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9104 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9105
9106 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9107 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9108 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9109 @end defmac
9110
9111 @node DBX Options
9112 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9113
9114 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9115 These are specific options for DBX output.
9116
9117 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9118 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9119 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9120 @end defmac
9121
9122 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9123 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9124 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9125 @end defmac
9126
9127 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9128 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9129 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9130 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9131 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9132 if there is any occasion to.
9133 @end defmac
9134
9135 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9136 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9137 in the text section.
9138 @end defmac
9139
9140 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9141 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9142 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9143 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9144 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9145 @end defmac
9146
9147 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9148 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9149 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9150 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9151 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9152 information format.
9153 @end defmac
9154
9155 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9156 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9157 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9158 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9159 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9160 @end defmac
9161
9162 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9163 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9164 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9165 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9166 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9167 @end defmac
9168
9169 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9170 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9171 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9172 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9173 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9174 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9175 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9176 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9177 @end defmac
9178
9179 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9180 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9181 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9182 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9183 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9184 if backslash is correct for your system.
9185 @end defmac
9186
9187 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9188 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9189 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9190 variable.
9191 @end defmac
9192
9193 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9194 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9195 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9196 @end defmac
9197
9198 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9199 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9200 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9201 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9202 @end defmac
9203
9204 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9205 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9206 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9207 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9208 @end defmac
9209
9210 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9211 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9212 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9213 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9214 @end defmac
9215
9216 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9217 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9218 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9219 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9220 code.
9221 @end defmac
9222
9223 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9224 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9225 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9226 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9227 an absolute address.
9228 @end defmac
9229
9230 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9231 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9232 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9233 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9234 @end defmac
9235
9236 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9237 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9238 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9239 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9240 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9241 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9242 number for a type number.
9243 @end defmac
9244
9245 @node DBX Hooks
9246 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9247
9248 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9249 These are hooks for DBX format.
9250
9251 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9252 Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9253 information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9254 argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9255 @code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9256 @end defmac
9257
9258 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9259 Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9260 @end defmac
9261
9262 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9263 Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9264 output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9265 @end defmac
9266
9267 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9268 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9269 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9270 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9271 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9272 unique labels in the assembly output.
9273
9274 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9275 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9276 @end defmac
9277
9278 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9279 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9280 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9281 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9282 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9283 @end defmac
9284
9285 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9286 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9287 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9288 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9289 @end defmac
9290
9291 @node File Names and DBX
9292 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9293
9294 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9295 This describes file names in DBX format.
9296
9297 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9298 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9299 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9300 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9301 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9302
9303 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9304 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9305
9306 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9307 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9308 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9309 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9310 @end defmac
9311
9312 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9313 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9314 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9315 the beginning of the file.
9316 @end defmac
9317
9318 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9319 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9320 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9321 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9322 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9323 @end defmac
9324
9325 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9326 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9327 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9328 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9329
9330 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9331 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9332 @end defmac
9333
9334 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9335 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9336 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9337 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9338 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9339 @end defmac
9340
9341 @need 2000
9342 @node SDB and DWARF
9343 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9344
9345 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9346 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9347
9348 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9349 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9350 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9351 @end defmac
9352
9353 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9354 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9355 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9356
9357 @hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9358 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9359 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9360 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9361 @end deftypefn
9362
9363 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9364 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9365 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9366 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9367 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9368 @end defmac
9369
9370 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9371 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9372 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9373 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9374 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9375 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9376 @end defmac
9377
9378 @hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9379 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9380 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9381 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9382 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9383
9384 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9385 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9386
9387 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9388 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9389 @end deftypefn
9390
9391 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9392 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9393 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9394 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9395 @end defmac
9396
9397 @hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9398
9399 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9400 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9401 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9402 @end defmac
9403
9404 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9405 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9406 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9407 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9408 @end defmac
9409
9410 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9411 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9412 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9413 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9414 @end defmac
9415
9416 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9417 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9418 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9419 @end defmac
9420
9421 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9422 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9423 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9424 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9425 is referenced by a function.
9426 @end defmac
9427
9428 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9429 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9430 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9431 @end deftypefn
9432
9433 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9434 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9435 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9436 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9437 not define them yourself.
9438 @end defmac
9439
9440 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9441 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9442 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9443 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9444 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9445 required.
9446 @end defmac
9447
9448 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9449 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9450 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9451 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9452 it.
9453 @end defmac
9454
9455 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9456 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9457 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9458 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9459 @end defmac
9460
9461 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9462 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9463 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9464 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9465 @end defmac
9466
9467 @need 2000
9468 @node VMS Debug
9469 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9470
9471 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9472 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9473
9474 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9475 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9476 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9477 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9478 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9479 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9480 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9481 @end defmac
9482
9483 @node Floating Point
9484 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9485 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9486 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9487
9488 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9489 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9490 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9491 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9492 doing the compilation.
9493
9494 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9495 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9496 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9497 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9498 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9499 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9500 target floating point formats are identical.
9501
9502 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9503 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9504 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9505 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9506
9507 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9508 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9509 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9510 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9511 quantity.
9512 @end defmac
9513
9514 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9515 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9516 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9517 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9518 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9519 @end deftypefn
9520
9521 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9522 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9523 @end deftypefn
9524
9525 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9526 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9527 @end deftypefn
9528
9529 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9530 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9531 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9532 @end deftypefn
9533
9534 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9535 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9536 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9537 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9538 defined by the C language for both.
9539 @end deftypefn
9540
9541 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9542 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9543 @end deftypefn
9544
9545 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9546 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9547 @end deftypefn
9548
9549 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9550 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9551 @end deftypefn
9552
9553 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9554 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9555 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9556 variable).
9557
9558 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9559 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9560 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9561
9562 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9563 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9564 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9565 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9566 @end deftypefn
9567
9568 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9569 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9570 @end deftypefn
9571
9572 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9573 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9574 @end deftypefn
9575
9576 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9577 Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9578 return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9579 appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9580 precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9581 @end deftypefn
9582
9583 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9584 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9585 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9586 integral, it is truncated.
9587 @end deftypefn
9588
9589 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9590 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9591 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9592 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9593 @end deftypefn
9594
9595 @node Mode Switching
9596 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9597 @cindex mode switching
9598 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9599
9600 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9601 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9602 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9603
9604 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9605 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9606 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9607 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9608 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9609 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9610 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9611
9612 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9613 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9614 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9615 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9616 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9617 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9618 @code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9619 are optional.
9620 @end defmac
9621
9622 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9623 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9624 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9625 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9626 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9627 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9628 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9629 entity in question.
9630 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9631 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9632 switch is needed / supplied.
9633 @end defmac
9634
9635 @defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9636 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9637 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9638 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9639 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9640 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9641 @end defmac
9642
9643 @defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9644 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9645 mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9646 different from the incoming mode).
9647 @end defmac
9648
9649 @defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9650 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9651 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9652 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9653 is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9654 @end defmac
9655
9656 @defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9657 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9658 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9659 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9660 is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9661 @end defmac
9662
9663 @defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9664 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
9665 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9666 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9667 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9668 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9669 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9670 @end defmac
9671
9672 @defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9673 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9674 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9675 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9676 @end defmac
9677
9678 @node Target Attributes
9679 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9680 @cindex target attributes
9681 @cindex machine attributes
9682 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9683
9684 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9685 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9686 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9687
9688 @hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9689 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9690 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9691 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9692 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9693 take.
9694 @end deftypevr
9695
9696 @hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9697 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9698 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9699 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9700 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9701 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9702 @end deftypefn
9703
9704 @hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9705 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9706 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9707 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9708 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9709 supposed always to be compatible.
9710 @end deftypefn
9711
9712 @hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9713 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9714 the newly defined @var{type}.
9715 @end deftypefn
9716
9717 @hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9718 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9719 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9720 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9721 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9722 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9723 merging.
9724 @end deftypefn
9725
9726 @hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9727 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9728 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9729 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9730 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9731 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9732 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9733 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9734
9735 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9736 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9737 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9738 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9739 will then define a function called
9740 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9741 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9742 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9743 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9744 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9745 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9746 @end deftypefn
9747
9748 @hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9749
9750 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9751 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9752 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9753 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9754 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9755 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9756 on this implementation detail.
9757 @end defmac
9758
9759 @hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9760 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9761 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9762 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9763 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9764 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9765 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9766 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9767 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9768 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9769 needed.
9770 @end deftypefn
9771
9772 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9773 @cindex inlining
9774 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9775 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9776 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9777 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9778 @end deftypefn
9779
9780 @hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9781 This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9782 it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9783 options for the current function that might be different than the
9784 options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9785 @code{true} if the options are valid.
9786
9787 The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9788 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9789 @var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9790 @end deftypefn
9791
9792 @hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9793 This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9794 in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9795 options.
9796 @xref{Option file format}.
9797 @end deftypefn
9798
9799 @hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9800 This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9801 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9802 function specific options.
9803 @end deftypefn
9804
9805 @hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9806 This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9807 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9808 function specific options.
9809 @end deftypefn
9810
9811 @hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
9812 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9813 set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9814 input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
9815 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9816 @end deftypefn
9817
9818 @hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9819 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9820 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9821 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9822 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9823
9824 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9825 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9826
9827 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9828 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9829 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9830 @end deftypefn
9831
9832 @hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9833 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9834 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9835 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9836 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9837 @end deftypefn
9838
9839 @node Emulated TLS
9840 @section Emulating TLS
9841 @cindex Emulated TLS
9842
9843 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9844 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9845 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9846 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9847 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9848 layer.
9849
9850 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9851 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9852 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9853 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9854
9855 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9856 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9857 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9858 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9859 @end deftypevr
9860
9861 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9862 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9863 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9864 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9865 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9866 registration function to be used.
9867 @end deftypevr
9868
9869 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9870 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9871 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9872 any section.
9873 @end deftypevr
9874
9875 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9876 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9877 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9878 section.
9879 @end deftypevr
9880
9881 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9882 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9883 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9884 @end deftypevr
9885
9886 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9887 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9888 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9889 @end deftypevr
9890
9891 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9892 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9893 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9894 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9895 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9896 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9897 @end deftypefn
9898
9899 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9900 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9901 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9902 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9903 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9904 @end deftypefn
9905
9906 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9907 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9908 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9909 single objects. The default is false.
9910 @end deftypevr
9911
9912 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9913 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9914 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9915 @end deftypevr
9916
9917 @node MIPS Coprocessors
9918 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9919 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9920
9921 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9922 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9923 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9924 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9925
9926 @smallexample
9927 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9928 unsigned int d;
9929
9930 d = cp0count + 3;
9931 @end smallexample
9932
9933 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9934 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9935 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9936
9937 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9938 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9939 later in the function.
9940
9941 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9942 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9943 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9944
9945 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9946 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9947
9948 @defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9949 A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9950 alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9951 @smallexample
9952 @{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9953 @end smallexample
9954 Default: empty.
9955 @end defmac
9956
9957 @node PCH Target
9958 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9959 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9960
9961 @hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9962 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9963 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9964 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9965 @end deftypefn
9966
9967 @hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9968 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9969 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9970 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9971 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9972
9973 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9974 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9975 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9976 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9977
9978 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9979 suitable for most targets.
9980 @end deftypefn
9981
9982 @hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9983 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9984 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9985 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9986 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9987 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9988 @end deftypefn
9989
9990 @node C++ ABI
9991 @section C++ ABI parameters
9992 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
9993
9994 @hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9995 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9996 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9997 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9998 @end deftypefn
9999
10000 @hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
10001 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10002 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10003 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10004 @end deftypefn
10005
10006 @hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
10007 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10008 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10009 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10010 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10011 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10012 @end deftypefn
10013
10014 @hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
10015 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10016 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10017 @end deftypefn
10018
10019 @hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
10020 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10021 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10022 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10023 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10024 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10025 backend's targeted operating system.
10026 @end deftypefn
10027
10028 @hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
10029 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10030 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10031 @code{false}.
10032 @end deftypefn
10033
10034 @hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
10035 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10036 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10037 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10038 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10039 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10040 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10041 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10042 @end deftypefn
10043
10044 @hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
10045
10046 @hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
10047 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10048 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10049 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10050 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10051 unit will not be COMDAT.
10052 @end deftypefn
10053
10054 @hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
10055 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10056 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10057 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10058 @end deftypefn
10059
10060 @hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10061 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10062 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10063 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10064 @end deftypefn
10065
10066 @hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10067 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10068 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10069 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10070 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10071 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10072 @end deftypefn
10073
10074 @hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10075
10076 @node Named Address Spaces
10077 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10078 @cindex named address spaces
10079
10080 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10081 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10082 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10083 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10084 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10085 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10086 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10087 @code{const} type attributes.
10088
10089 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10090 pointers to the generic address space.
10091
10092 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10093 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10094 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10095 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10096 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10097 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10098 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10099 always 32 bits).
10100
10101 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10102 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10103 address space.
10104
10105 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10106 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10107 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10108 named address space #1:
10109 @smallexample
10110 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10111 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10112 @end smallexample
10113
10114 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10115 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10116 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10117 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10118 generic address space only.
10119 @end deftypefn
10120
10121 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10122 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10123 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10124 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10125 generic address space only.
10126 @end deftypefn
10127
10128 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10129 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10130 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10131 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10132 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10133 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10134 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10135 target hooks for the given address space.
10136 @end deftypefn
10137
10138 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10139 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10140 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10141 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10142 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10143 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10144 explicit named address space support.
10145 @end deftypefn
10146
10147 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10148 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10149 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10150 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10151 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10152 @end deftypefn
10153
10154 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10155 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10156 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10157 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10158 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10159 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10160 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10161 @end deftypefn
10162
10163 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10164 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10165 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10166 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10167 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10168 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10169 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10170 @end deftypefn
10171
10172 @node Misc
10173 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10174 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10175
10176 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10177 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10178
10179 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10180 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10181 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10182 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10183 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10184 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10185 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10186 @end defmac
10187
10188 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10189 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10190 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10191 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10192 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10193 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10194 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10195 @end defmac
10196
10197 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10198 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10199 elements of a jump-table should have.
10200 @end defmac
10201
10202 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10203 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10204 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10205 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10206 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10207 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10208 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10209 flags can be updated.
10210 @end defmac
10211
10212 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10213 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10214 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10215 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10216 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10217 is in effect.
10218 @end defmac
10219
10220 @hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10221 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10222 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10223 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10224 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10225 @end deftypefn
10226
10227 @defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10228 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10229 statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10230 advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10231 of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10232 targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10233 @code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10234 @code{false} otherwise.
10235 @end defmac
10236
10237 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10238 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10239 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10240 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10241 @end defmac
10242
10243 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10244 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10245 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10246 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10247 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10248 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10249 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10250 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10251
10252 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10253 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10254 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10255 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10256 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10257
10258 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10259 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10260 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10261 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10262 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10263
10264 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10265 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10266 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10267 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10268 @end defmac
10269
10270 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10271 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10272 extends.
10273 @end defmac
10274
10275 @defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10276 Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10277 point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10278 unsigned one.
10279 @end defmac
10280
10281 @hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10282 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10283 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10284 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10285 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10286 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10287 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10288 @end deftypefn
10289
10290 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10291 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10292 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10293 @end defmac
10294
10295 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10296 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10297 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10298 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10299 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10300 at run-time.
10301 @end defmac
10302
10303 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10304 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10305 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10306 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10307 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10308 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10309 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10310 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10311 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10312 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10313 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10314
10315 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10316 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10317 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10318
10319 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10320 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10321 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10322 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10323 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10324
10325 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10326 @end defmac
10327
10328 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10329 @hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10330 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10331 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10332 @xref{shift patterns}.
10333
10334 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10335 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10336 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10337 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10338 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10339 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10340
10341 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10342 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10343 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10344
10345 The default implementation of this function returns
10346 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10347 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10348 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10349 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10350 by overriding it.
10351 @end deftypefn
10352
10353 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10354 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10355 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10356 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10357 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10358
10359 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10360
10361 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10362 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10363 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10364 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10365 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10366 such cases may improve things.
10367 @end defmac
10368
10369 @hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10370 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10371 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10372 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10373 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10374 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10375 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10376 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10377 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10378 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10379 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10380
10381 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10382 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10383 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10384 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10385
10386 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10387 describe two related properties. If you define
10388 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10389 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10390 extension.
10391
10392 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10393 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10394 @code{mode}.
10395 @end deftypefn
10396
10397 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10398 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10399 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10400 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10401 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10402 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10403
10404 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10405 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10406 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10407 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10408 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10409 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10410 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10411 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10412 the compiler.
10413
10414 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10415 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10416 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10417 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10418 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10419 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10420 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10421 expression
10422
10423 @smallexample
10424 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10425 @end smallexample
10426
10427 @noindent
10428 can be converted to
10429
10430 @smallexample
10431 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10432 @end smallexample
10433
10434 @noindent
10435 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10436 tested into the sign bit.
10437
10438 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10439 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10440 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10441 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10442 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10443 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10444
10445 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10446 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10447 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10448 to be used:
10449
10450 @itemize @bullet
10451 @item
10452 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10453 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10454 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10455 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10456 combine the normalization with other operations.
10457
10458 @item
10459 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10460 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10461 other machines.
10462
10463 @item
10464 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10465 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10466 others.
10467
10468 @item
10469 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10470 @end itemize
10471
10472 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10473 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10474 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10475 those cases, e.g., one matching
10476
10477 @smallexample
10478 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10479 @end smallexample
10480
10481 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10482 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10483 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10484 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10485 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10486 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10487 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
10488 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10489
10490 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10491 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10492 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10493 @end defmac
10494
10495 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10496 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10497 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10498 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10499 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10500 this macro.
10501 @end defmac
10502
10503 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10504 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10505 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10506 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10507 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10508 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10509 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10510 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10511 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10512 given mode.
10513 @end defmac
10514
10515 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10516 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10517 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10518 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10519 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10520 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10521 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10522 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10523 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10524 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10525 this value.
10526
10527 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10528 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10529
10530 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10531 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10532 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10533 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10534
10535 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10536 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10537 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10538 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10539 breaking the API@.
10540 @end defmac
10541
10542 @defmac Pmode
10543 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10544 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10545 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10546 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10547 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10548
10549 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10550 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10551 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10552 to @code{Pmode}.
10553 @end defmac
10554
10555 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10556 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10557 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10558 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10559 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10560 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10561 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10562 @end defmac
10563
10564 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10565 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10566 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10567 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10568 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10569 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10570
10571 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10572 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10573 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10574 @end defmac
10575
10576 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10577 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10578 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10579 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10580 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10581 @end defmac
10582
10583 @findex #pragma
10584 @findex pragma
10585 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10586 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10587 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10588 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10589 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10590 setup required for the pragmas.
10591
10592 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10593 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10594 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10595
10596 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10597 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10598
10599 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10600 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10601 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10602 @end defmac
10603
10604 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10605 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10606
10607 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10608 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10609 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10610 pragma of the form
10611
10612 @smallexample
10613 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10614 @end smallexample
10615
10616 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10617 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10618 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10619 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10620 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10621 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10622 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10623 arguments of pragmas registered with
10624 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10625 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10626
10627 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10628 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10629 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10630 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10631 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10632 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10633 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10634 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10635 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10636 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10637 how to build this object file.
10638 @end deftypefun
10639
10640 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10641 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10642 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10643 @end defmac
10644
10645 @hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10646
10647 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10648 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10649 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10650 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10651 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10652 @end defmac
10653
10654 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10655 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10656 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10657 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10658 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10659 @end defmac
10660
10661 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10662 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10663 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10664 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10665 @samp{.} is used instead.
10666 @end defmac
10667
10668 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10669 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10670 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10671 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10672 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10673 @end defmac
10674
10675 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10676 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10677 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10678 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10679 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10680 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10681 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10682 you should define this macro.
10683
10684 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10685 @end defmac
10686
10687 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10688 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10689 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10690 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10691 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10692 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10693 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10694 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10695 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10696 slot of @var{insn}.
10697
10698 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10699 @end defmac
10700
10701 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10702 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10703 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10704 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10705 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10706 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10707
10708 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10709 @end defmac
10710
10711 @hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10712 This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10713 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10714 It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10715 clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10716 corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10717 clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10718 @code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10719 for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10720 @end deftypefn
10721
10722 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10723 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10724 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10725 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10726 separate math library.
10727
10728 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10729 @end defmac
10730
10731 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10732 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10733 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10734
10735 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10736 is wrong.
10737 @end defmac
10738
10739 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10740 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10741 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10742 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10743 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10744 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10745 for cross-profiling.
10746 @end defmac
10747
10748 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10749
10750 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10751 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10752 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
10753 1 if it does use cc0.
10754 @end defmac
10755
10756 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10757 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10758 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10759 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10760 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10761 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10762 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10763 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10764 @end defmac
10765
10766 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10767 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10768 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10769 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10770 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10771 @end defmac
10772
10773 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10774 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10775 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10776 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10777 about the currently processed blocks.
10778 @end defmac
10779
10780 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10781 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10782 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10783 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10784 to by @var{ce_info}.
10785 @end defmac
10786
10787 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10788 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10789 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10790 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10791 to by @var{ce_info}.
10792 @end defmac
10793
10794 @defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10795 A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10796 structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10797 @end defmac
10798
10799 @defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10800 If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10801 added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10802 by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10803 @end defmac
10804
10805 @hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10806 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10807 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10808 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10809
10810 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10811 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10812 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10813 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10814
10815 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10816 definition is null.
10817 @end deftypefn
10818
10819 @hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10820 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10821 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10822 necessary setup.
10823
10824 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10825 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10826 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10827 instructions or prefetch instructions).
10828
10829 To create a built-in function, call the function
10830 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10831 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10832 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
10833 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10834 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10835 @end deftypefn
10836
10837 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10838 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10839 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10840 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10841 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10842 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10843 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10844 @code{error_mark_node}.
10845 @end deftypefn
10846
10847 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10848
10849 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10850 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10851 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10852 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10853 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10854 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10855 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10856 built-in function.
10857 @end deftypefn
10858
10859 @hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
10860 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10861 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10862 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10863 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10864 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10865 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10866 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10867 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10868 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10869 @end deftypefn
10870
10871 @hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
10872 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10873 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10874 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10875 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10876 The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10877 call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10878 @end deftypefn
10879
10880 @hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10881
10882 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10883 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10884 could not be applied.
10885
10886 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10887 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10888 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10889 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10890 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10891 @end deftypefn
10892
10893 @defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10894
10895 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10896 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10897 @var{branch2} is possible.
10898
10899 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10900 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10901 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10902 @end defmac
10903
10904 @hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10905 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10906 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10907 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10908 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10909 @end deftypefn
10910
10911 @hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10912
10913 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10914 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10915 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10916 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10917 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10918 that had its initial value copied by using
10919 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10920 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10921 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10922 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10923 @code{MEM}.
10924 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10925 it might decide to use another register anyways.
10926 You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10927 that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10928 register in question will not be clobbered.
10929 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10930 allocation.
10931 @end deftypefn
10932
10933 @hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10934 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10935 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10936 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10937 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10938 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10939 passed along.
10940 @end deftypefn
10941
10942 @hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
10943 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10944 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10945 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10946 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10947 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10948 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10949 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10950 and is returning to processing at the top level.
10951 The default hook function does nothing.
10952
10953 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10954 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10955 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10956 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10957 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10958 outside of any function scope.
10959 @end deftypefn
10960
10961 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10962 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10963 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10964 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10965 @end defmac
10966
10967 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10968 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10969 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
10970 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10971 executable files.
10972 @end defmac
10973
10974 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
10975 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10976 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10977 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10978 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10979 lists.
10980 @end defmac
10981
10982 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
10983 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10984 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10985 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
10986 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
10987 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10988 defined as this expression:
10989
10990 @smallexample
10991 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10992 build_tree_list
10993 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
10994 NULL))
10995 @end smallexample
10996 @end defmac
10997
10998 @hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
10999 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11000 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11001 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11002 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11003
11004 @smallexample
11005 static bool
11006 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11007 @{
11008 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11009 @}
11010 @end smallexample
11011 @end deftypefn
11012
11013 @hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
11014 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11015 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11016 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11017 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11018 to inter-block scheduling.
11019 @end deftypefn
11020
11021 @hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
11022 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11023 registers
11024 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11025 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11026 that all target registers in the class returned by
11027 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11028 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11029 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11030 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11031 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11032 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11033 @end deftypefn
11034
11035 @hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
11036 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11037 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11038 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11039 @end deftypefn
11040
11041 @hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
11042 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11043 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11044 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11045 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11046 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11047 number of memory accesses.
11048 @end deftypefn
11049
11050 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11051 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11052 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11053 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11054 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11055 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11056 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11057 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11058 @end defmac
11059
11060 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11061 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11062 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11063 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11064 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11065 @end deftypefn
11066
11067 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11068 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11069 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11070 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11071 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11072 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11073 @end deftypefn
11074
11075 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11076 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11077 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11078 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11079 that are different from @option{-I}.
11080 @end deftypefn
11081
11082 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11083 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11084 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11085 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11086 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11087 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11088 @end defmac
11089
11090 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11091 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11092 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11093 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11094 @end defmac
11095
11096 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11097 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11098 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11099 @end defmac
11100
11101 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11102 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11103 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11104 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11105 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11106 @end defmac
11107
11108 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11109 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11110 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11111 @end defmac
11112
11113 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11114 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11115 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11116 and scanf formatter settings.
11117 @end defmac
11118
11119 @hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11120 If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11121 guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11122 main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11123 important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11124 many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11125 ``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11126 and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11127 @end deftypevr
11128
11129 @hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11130 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11131 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11132 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11133 @end deftypefn
11134
11135 @hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11136 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11137 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11138 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11139 @end deftypefn
11140
11141 @hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11142 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11143 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11144 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11145 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11146 @end deftypefn
11147
11148 @hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11149 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11150 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11151 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11152 the front end.
11153 @end deftypefn
11154
11155 @hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11156 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11157 invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11158 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11159 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11160 @end deftypefn
11161
11162 @hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11163 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11164 invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11165 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11166 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11167 @end deftypefn
11168
11169 @hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
11170 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11171 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11172 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11173 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11174 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11175 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11176 @end deftypefn
11177
11178 @hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
11179 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11180 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11181 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11182 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11183 conversion rules.
11184 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11185 @end deftypefn
11186
11187 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11188 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11189 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11190 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11191 @end defmac
11192
11193 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11194 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11195 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11196 @end defmac
11197
11198 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11199 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11200 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11201 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11202 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11203 @end defmac
11204
11205 @hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11206 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11207 necessary.
11208 @end deftypefn
11209
11210 @hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11211 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11212 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11213 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11214 is needed.
11215 @end deftypefn
11216
11217 @hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11218 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11219 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11220 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11221 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11222 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11223 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11224 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11225 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11226 @end deftypefn
11227
11228 @hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11229 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11230 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11231 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11232 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11233 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11234 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11235 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11236 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11237 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11238 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11239 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11240 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11241 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11242 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11243 is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr